1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.85"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
441 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
447 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
450 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
495 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496 .cindex "training courses"
497 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
551 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
556 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
565 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
569 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
574 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
579 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
583 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
585 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
586 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
593 .cindex "domainless addresses"
594 .cindex "address" "without domain"
595 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
601 .cindex "transport" "external"
602 .cindex "external transports"
603 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
610 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
615 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619 a number of common scanners are provided.
623 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
631 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
640 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
644 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
651 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652 .cindex "terminology definitions"
653 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656 below) by a blank line.
658 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665 rise to further bounce messages.
667 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
672 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
677 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
681 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
682 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
683 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
690 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
692 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
698 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
699 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
700 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
704 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
711 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
712 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
715 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
721 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
727 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
742 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743 .cindex "incorporated code"
744 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
747 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
750 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
757 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762 following statements:
765 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
767 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
771 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775 restrictions applied to it).
778 .cindex "SPA authentication"
779 .cindex "Samba project"
780 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
787 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792 conditions expressed therein.
795 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
797 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
802 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
805 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
810 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813 details, please contact
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
823 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
826 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
829 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
840 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
843 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
849 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
854 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860 software without specific, written prior permission.
862 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
872 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
880 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
892 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
896 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897 .cindex "design philosophy"
898 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
906 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
908 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
915 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
926 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
929 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
934 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
940 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
944 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946 runs at the start of every delivery process.
951 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
952 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
953 .cindex "Sieve filter"
954 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959 of filtering are available:
962 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
965 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
969 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
973 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975 .cindex "format" "of message id"
976 .cindex "id of message"
981 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988 not always case-sensitive.
990 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
999 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002 way of representing the date and time of day).
1004 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005 received the message.
1007 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1009 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1015 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017 (1/100) of a second.
1021 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1028 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029 .cindex "receiving mail"
1030 .cindex "message" "reception"
1031 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034 there are several possibilities:
1037 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1041 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1048 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1054 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1061 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073 users to change sender addresses.
1075 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1083 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088 message is received.
1094 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1103 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112 affect file system performance.
1114 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1120 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1135 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136 .cindex "message" "life of"
1137 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1138 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1145 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1152 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1158 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1159 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1170 .cindex "journal file"
1171 .cindex "file" "journal"
1172 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1181 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185 deliveries caused by crashes.
1189 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1199 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207 the driver's features in general.
1209 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1215 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1222 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1229 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1234 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242 configured to fail the address.
1244 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1251 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256 the address is bounced.
1260 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1262 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1269 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1281 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282 .cindex "router" "running details"
1283 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1285 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1292 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294 original address ceases,
1295 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1302 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1308 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1314 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1320 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1324 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1329 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1333 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1339 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343 facility for this purpose.
1346 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347 .cindex "case of local parts"
1348 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354 routed addresses are shown.
1358 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1410 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1413 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417 remaining preconditions.
1419 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423 could lead to confusion.
1425 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426 set of addresses that it defines.
1428 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429 specified files is tested.
1431 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1438 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1448 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1453 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1459 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1462 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1470 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474 processed entirely independently of each other.
1476 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1486 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493 addresses to the same domain.
1495 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1504 .cindex "queue runner"
1505 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1515 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1522 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525 messages to other addresses.
1527 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1532 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1540 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543 .cindex "queue runner"
1544 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551 passed its retry time.
1552 You can run several queue runners at once.
1554 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1563 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1574 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1578 .cindex "hints database"
1579 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1587 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1599 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1604 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1615 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1631 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1634 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1640 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1643 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1650 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651 following subdirectories are created:
1654 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1663 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665 that may be useful to some sites.
1668 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1675 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679 overridden if necessary.
1682 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683 .cindex "PCRE library"
1684 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692 If your operating system has no
1693 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1697 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1705 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1714 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721 Berkeley DB library.
1723 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1728 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1731 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735 file name is used unmodified.
1737 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1742 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1746 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1748 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1753 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756 operates on a single file.
1760 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1768 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1771 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1778 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780 in one of these lines:
1785 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1791 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1794 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1799 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1812 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1819 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1827 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830 facilities, you need to set
1832 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1834 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1838 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1846 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1855 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1858 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1866 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1874 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1878 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1890 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1894 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1897 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1899 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1903 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1906 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1910 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1912 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1917 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920 library and include files. For example:
1924 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1927 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1932 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1935 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1942 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1944 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1958 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1962 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1965 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1967 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1976 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1984 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. Exim used to
1989 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1994 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1995 .cindex "lookup modules"
1996 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1997 .cindex ".so building"
1998 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1999 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2001 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2002 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2004 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2006 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2007 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2008 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2009 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2010 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2011 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2013 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2014 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2015 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2024 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2025 .cindex "build directory"
2026 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2027 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2028 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2029 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2030 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2031 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2032 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2034 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2035 building process fails if it is set.
2037 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2038 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2039 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2040 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2041 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2042 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2043 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2044 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2046 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2047 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2048 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2052 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2053 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2054 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2055 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2056 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2057 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2058 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2062 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2063 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2064 given in addition to the short output.
2068 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2069 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2070 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2071 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2072 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2073 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2074 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2077 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2078 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2080 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2081 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2082 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2083 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2085 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2086 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2087 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2088 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2089 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2090 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2091 and are often not needed.
2093 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2094 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2095 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2096 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2097 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2098 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2099 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2100 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2101 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2104 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2105 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2106 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2107 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2111 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2112 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2113 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2114 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2115 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2116 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2117 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2118 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2119 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2120 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2121 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2122 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2123 containing the lines
2128 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2129 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2131 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2132 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2133 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2136 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2137 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2138 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2139 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2140 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2141 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2142 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2143 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2144 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2145 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2151 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2152 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2153 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2154 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2155 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2156 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2157 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2158 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2161 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2162 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2163 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2164 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2165 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2166 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2167 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2168 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2169 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2170 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2171 syntax. For instance:
2174 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2176 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2177 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2178 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2181 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2182 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2183 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2187 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2188 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2190 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2191 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2192 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2193 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2194 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2195 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2198 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2199 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2201 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2202 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2205 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2206 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2208 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2209 definition of all three of these variables into your
2210 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2213 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2214 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2215 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2216 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2218 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2219 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2220 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2221 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2222 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2225 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2226 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2227 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2228 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2229 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2232 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2234 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2235 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2236 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2237 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2238 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2239 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2243 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2244 .cindex "building Eximon"
2245 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2246 where the files that are involved are
2248 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2249 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2250 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2251 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2252 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2253 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2255 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2256 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2257 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2258 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2259 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2260 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2261 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2265 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2266 .cindex "installing Exim"
2267 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2268 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2269 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2270 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2271 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2272 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2273 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2274 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2275 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2276 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2277 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2278 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2280 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2281 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2282 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2283 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2284 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2285 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2286 alternative files, no default is installed.
2288 .cindex "system aliases file"
2289 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2290 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2291 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2292 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2293 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2294 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2295 and outputs a comment to the user.
2297 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2298 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2299 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2300 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2301 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2303 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2304 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2305 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2306 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2307 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2310 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2311 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2314 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2316 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2317 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2318 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2319 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2320 but this usage is deprecated.
2322 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2323 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2324 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2325 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2326 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2327 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2329 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2330 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2331 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2332 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2333 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2334 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2335 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2337 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2338 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2339 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2342 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2344 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2345 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2346 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2347 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2350 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2352 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2353 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2356 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2357 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2359 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2363 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2365 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2367 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2368 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2369 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2371 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2376 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2377 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2378 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2379 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2380 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2383 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2384 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2385 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2389 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2390 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2391 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2392 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2393 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2399 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2400 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2401 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2402 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2403 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2407 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2408 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2409 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2410 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2411 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2414 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2416 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2418 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2420 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2421 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2422 user agent. For example:
2424 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2425 From: user@your.domain.example
2426 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2427 Subject: Testing Exim
2429 This is a test message.
2432 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2433 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2434 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2436 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2437 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2438 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2439 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2440 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2441 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2443 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2445 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2446 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2447 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2448 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2449 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2451 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2452 .cindex "lock files"
2453 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2454 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2455 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2456 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2457 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2458 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2459 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2460 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2461 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2462 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2463 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2464 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2466 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2467 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2468 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2469 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2470 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2473 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2474 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2475 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2476 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2480 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2481 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2482 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2483 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2484 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2485 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2486 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2487 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2488 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2489 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2490 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2491 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2492 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2494 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2495 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2496 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2497 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2498 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2499 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2502 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2503 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2504 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2505 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2507 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2508 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2509 favourite user agent.
2511 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2512 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2513 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2514 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2515 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2516 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2520 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2521 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2522 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2523 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2524 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2525 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2526 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2527 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2533 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2534 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2535 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2537 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2539 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2540 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2541 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2542 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2543 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2545 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2547 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2549 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2550 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2551 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2556 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2557 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2559 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2560 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2561 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2562 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2563 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2564 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2565 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2566 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2567 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2570 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2572 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2573 were present before any other options.
2574 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2576 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2577 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2578 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2581 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2582 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2583 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2587 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2588 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2589 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2592 .cindex "queue runner"
2593 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2594 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2595 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2597 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2598 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2599 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2600 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2601 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2602 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2603 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2604 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2607 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2608 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2609 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2610 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2611 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2612 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2615 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2616 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2617 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2618 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2619 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2620 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2622 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2623 .cindex "envelope sender"
2624 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2625 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2626 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2627 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2628 users to set envelope senders.
2630 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2631 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2632 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2633 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2634 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2636 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2637 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2638 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2639 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2640 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2641 that are available to trusted users.
2643 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2644 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2645 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2646 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2647 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2649 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2650 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2651 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2652 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2654 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2655 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2656 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2657 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2659 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2660 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2665 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2666 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2667 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2673 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2674 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2675 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2676 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2677 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2678 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2679 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2680 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2682 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2683 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2684 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2685 . creates a man page for the options.
2686 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2689 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2696 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2697 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2698 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2699 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2702 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2703 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2704 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2707 .vitem &%--version%&
2708 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2709 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2716 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2719 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2721 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2722 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2723 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2724 clean; it ignores this option.
2729 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2730 .cindex "queue runner"
2731 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2732 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2733 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2735 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2736 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2737 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2738 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2740 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2741 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2742 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2743 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2745 When a listening daemon
2746 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2747 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2748 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2749 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2750 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2751 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2754 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2755 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2756 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2760 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2761 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2762 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2763 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2764 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2765 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2766 because these are reread each time they are used.
2770 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2771 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2775 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2776 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2777 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2778 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2779 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2780 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2782 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2783 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2784 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2785 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2786 test data. A line history is supported.
2788 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2789 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2790 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2791 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2792 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2793 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2794 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2796 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2797 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2798 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2799 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2801 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2803 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2804 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2805 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2806 of a file. For example:
2808 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2810 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2811 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2812 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2813 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2814 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2815 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2816 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2819 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2821 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2822 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2823 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2824 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2825 system filters are recognized.
2827 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2829 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2830 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2831 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2832 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2833 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2834 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2835 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2836 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2839 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2840 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2841 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2843 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2845 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2846 variables that are used by the user filter.
2848 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2853 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2854 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2855 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2858 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2859 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2860 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2861 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2863 When testing a filter file,
2864 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2865 .cindex "envelope sender"
2866 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2867 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2868 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2869 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2870 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2873 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2875 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2876 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2877 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2880 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2882 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2883 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2884 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2885 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2886 actually being delivered.
2888 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2890 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2891 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2894 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2896 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2897 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2900 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2902 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2903 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2904 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2905 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2906 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2907 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2908 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2909 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2910 after a full stop. For example:
2912 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2913 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2915 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2916 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2917 conversion to the canonical form is
2918 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2920 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2921 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2922 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2923 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2924 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2928 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2929 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2930 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2933 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2934 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2935 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2937 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2938 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2939 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2940 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2941 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2942 session were authenticated.
2944 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2945 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2946 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2948 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2949 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2950 specialized SMTP test program such as
2951 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2953 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2955 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2956 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2957 updating the callout cache database.
2961 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2962 .cindex "building alias file"
2963 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2964 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2965 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2966 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2967 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2970 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2971 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2972 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2973 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2974 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2975 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2978 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2980 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2981 .cindex "querying exim information"
2982 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2983 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2984 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2985 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2986 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2989 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2990 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2991 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2992 recognised DSCP names.
2994 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2995 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2996 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2997 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2998 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2999 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3000 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3001 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3002 way to guarantee a correct response.
3006 .cindex "local message reception"
3007 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3008 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3009 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3010 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3011 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3012 if no other conflicting option is present.
3014 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3015 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3016 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3017 suppressing this for special cases.
3019 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3020 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3022 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3023 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3024 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3027 .cindex "message" "format"
3028 .cindex "format" "message"
3029 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3030 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3031 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3032 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3033 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3035 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3036 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3038 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3039 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3040 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3041 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3042 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3044 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3045 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3046 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3047 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3048 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3050 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3051 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3052 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3053 .cindex "malware scan test"
3054 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3055 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3056 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3057 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3058 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3059 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3061 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3062 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3063 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3064 This option requires admin privileges.
3066 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3067 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3068 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3072 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3073 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3074 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3075 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3076 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3077 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3078 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3080 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3081 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3082 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3083 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3084 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3086 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3087 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3088 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3089 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3094 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3095 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3096 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3097 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3098 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3099 arguments, for example:
3101 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3103 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3104 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3105 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3106 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3107 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3108 users, the output is as in this example:
3110 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3112 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3113 configuration file is output.
3114 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3115 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3117 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3118 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3119 name will not be output.
3121 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3122 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3123 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3124 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3125 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3126 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3127 written directly into the spool directory.
3129 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3131 exim -bP +local_domains
3133 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3134 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3136 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3137 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3138 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3139 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3140 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3141 that driver are output. For example:
3143 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3145 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3146 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3147 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3148 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3149 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3152 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3153 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3154 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3155 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3156 The output format is one item per line.
3160 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3161 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3162 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3163 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3164 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3165 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3166 to allow any user to see the queue.
3168 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3170 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3171 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3174 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3175 .cindex "size" "of message"
3176 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3177 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3178 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3179 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3180 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3181 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3182 before the sender address.
3184 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3185 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3186 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3188 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3189 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3190 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3191 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3192 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3198 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3199 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3200 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3206 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3207 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3208 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3209 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3214 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3215 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3216 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3217 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3221 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3225 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3230 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3231 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3232 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3233 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3238 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3239 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3240 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3241 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3242 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3244 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3245 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3247 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3248 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3249 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3250 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3251 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3252 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3253 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3254 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3255 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3257 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3258 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3263 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3264 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3265 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3266 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3267 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3268 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3269 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3273 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3274 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3275 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3276 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3277 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3278 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3279 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3280 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3281 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3283 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3284 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3285 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3287 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3288 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3289 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3290 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3292 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3293 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3294 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3296 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3297 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3298 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3299 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3300 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3302 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3303 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3307 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3308 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3309 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3310 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3311 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3312 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3313 messages to the MTA.
3316 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3317 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3318 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3319 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3320 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3321 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3322 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3326 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3327 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3328 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3329 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3330 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3331 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3332 the listening daemon.
3336 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3337 .cindex "address" "testing"
3338 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3339 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3340 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3341 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3342 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3344 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3345 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3347 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3348 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3351 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3352 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3353 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3354 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3355 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3358 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3359 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3360 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3361 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3363 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3364 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3365 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3366 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3369 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3370 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3372 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3373 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3374 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3375 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3376 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3377 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3382 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3383 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3384 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3385 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3386 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3387 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3389 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3390 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3391 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3392 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3393 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3394 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3395 dynamic testing facilities.
3399 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3400 .cindex "address" "verification"
3401 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3402 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3403 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3404 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3405 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3406 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3408 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3409 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3410 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3412 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3413 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3415 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3416 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3419 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3420 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3421 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3422 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3423 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3425 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3426 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3427 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3428 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3429 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3430 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3433 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3434 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3435 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3438 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3439 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3440 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3441 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3443 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3444 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3445 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3446 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3450 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3451 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3458 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3459 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3460 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3461 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3463 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3464 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3465 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3466 each port only when the first connection is received.
3468 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3469 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3471 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3473 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3474 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3475 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3476 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3477 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3478 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3479 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3480 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3481 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3483 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3484 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3485 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3486 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3487 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3488 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3489 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3490 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3491 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3493 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3494 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3495 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3496 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3497 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3498 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3499 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3501 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3502 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3503 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3504 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3505 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3506 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3507 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3509 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3510 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3511 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3514 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3515 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3516 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3517 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3518 specified by this option.
3521 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3523 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3524 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3525 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3526 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3527 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3528 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3530 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3531 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3532 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3533 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3534 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3535 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3536 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3538 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3539 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3540 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3546 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3547 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3550 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3552 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3555 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3557 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3558 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3559 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3560 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3561 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3562 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3563 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3566 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3567 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3568 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3569 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3570 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3571 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3572 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3575 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3576 &`auth `& authenticators
3577 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3578 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3579 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3580 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3581 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3582 &`filter `& filter handling
3583 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3584 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3585 &`ident `& ident lookup
3586 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3587 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3588 &`load `& system load checks
3589 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3590 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3591 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3592 &`memory `& memory handling
3593 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3594 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3595 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3596 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3597 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3598 &`retry `& retry handling
3599 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3600 &`route `& address routing
3601 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3603 &`transport `& transports
3604 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3605 &`verify `& address verification logic
3606 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3608 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3609 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3610 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3611 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3612 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3613 turn everything off.
3615 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3616 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3617 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3618 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3619 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3622 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3623 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3624 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3625 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3626 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3629 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3630 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3633 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3634 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3636 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3638 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3639 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3640 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3641 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3644 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3645 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3646 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3647 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3651 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3652 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3653 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3654 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3655 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3656 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3657 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3658 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3661 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3662 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3663 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3664 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3665 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3667 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3669 .cindex "sender" "name"
3670 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3671 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3672 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3673 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3674 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3675 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3677 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3679 .cindex "sender" "address"
3680 .cindex "address" "sender"
3681 .cindex "trusted users"
3682 .cindex "envelope sender"
3683 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3684 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3685 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3686 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3689 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3690 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3691 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3692 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3695 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3696 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3697 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3698 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3699 examples of shell commands:
3701 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3702 exim -f "" user@domain
3704 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3705 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3708 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3709 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3710 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3711 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3714 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3715 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3716 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3717 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3718 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3719 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3723 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3724 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3726 control = suppress_local_fixups
3728 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3729 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3732 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3735 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3737 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3738 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3739 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3744 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3745 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3746 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3747 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3748 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3749 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3751 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3753 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3754 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3755 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3756 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3757 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3758 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3760 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3762 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3764 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3765 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3766 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3767 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3768 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3769 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3770 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3773 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3774 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3775 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3776 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3777 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3778 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3780 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3781 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3782 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3783 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3785 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3787 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3788 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3789 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3790 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3791 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3792 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3793 can be used only by an admin user.
3795 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3796 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3798 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3799 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3800 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3801 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3802 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3803 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3804 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3805 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3809 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3810 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3811 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3816 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3817 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3818 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3823 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3824 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3825 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3827 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3829 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3830 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3831 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3832 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3833 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3834 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3838 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3839 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3840 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3845 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3846 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3847 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3849 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3851 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3852 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3853 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3854 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3855 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3856 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3857 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3858 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3859 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3860 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3861 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3862 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3863 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3865 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3867 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3868 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3869 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3870 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3871 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3872 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3873 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3874 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3876 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3878 .cindex "freezing messages"
3879 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3880 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3881 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3882 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3883 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3884 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3887 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3889 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3890 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3891 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3892 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3893 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3894 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3895 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3896 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3899 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3901 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3902 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3903 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3904 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3905 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3907 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3909 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3910 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3911 .cindex "removing recipients"
3912 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3913 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3914 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3915 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3916 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3917 can be used only by an admin user.
3919 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3921 .cindex "removing messages"
3922 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3923 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3924 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3925 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3926 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3927 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3928 placed on the queue.
3930 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3932 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3933 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3934 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3935 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3936 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3937 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3938 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3939 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3940 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3942 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3944 .cindex "thawing messages"
3945 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3946 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3947 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3948 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3949 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3950 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3953 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3955 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3956 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3957 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3958 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3960 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3962 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3963 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3964 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3965 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3966 only by an admin user.
3968 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3970 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3971 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3972 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3973 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3974 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3976 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3978 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3979 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3980 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3981 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3985 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3986 treats it that way too.
3990 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3991 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3992 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3993 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3994 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3995 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3996 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3999 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4000 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4001 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4002 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4003 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4004 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4005 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4010 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4011 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4012 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4014 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4016 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4019 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4021 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4022 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4023 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4026 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4028 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4029 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4030 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4031 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4032 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4033 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4037 .cindex "background delivery"
4038 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4039 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4040 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4041 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4042 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4043 processes to finish.
4045 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4046 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4047 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4048 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4050 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4051 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4052 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4053 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4057 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4058 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4059 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4060 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4061 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4062 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4064 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4065 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4068 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4069 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4071 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4072 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4073 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4074 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4079 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4084 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4085 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4086 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4087 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4088 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4089 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4090 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4091 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4092 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4093 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4098 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4099 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4100 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4101 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4102 configuration file is in effect.
4104 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4105 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4106 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4107 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4108 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4109 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4110 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4111 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4112 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4117 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4118 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4119 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4122 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4124 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4125 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4126 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4127 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4131 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4132 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4133 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4134 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4135 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4139 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4140 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4141 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4142 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4143 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4147 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4148 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4153 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4154 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4159 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4160 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4161 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4162 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4163 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4164 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4167 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4168 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4170 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4172 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4173 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4174 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4175 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4176 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4177 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4179 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4180 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4182 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4184 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4185 followed by a colon and the port number:
4187 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4189 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4190 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4191 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4192 whichever one is last.
4194 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4196 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4197 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4198 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4199 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4200 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4201 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4203 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4205 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4206 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4207 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4208 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4209 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4210 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4212 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4214 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4215 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4216 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4217 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4218 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4219 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4220 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4221 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4223 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4225 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4226 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4227 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4228 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4229 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4231 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4233 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4234 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4235 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4236 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4237 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4238 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4239 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4241 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4242 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4243 is sending the bounce.
4245 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4247 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4248 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4249 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4250 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4251 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4252 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4253 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4254 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4255 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4258 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4260 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4261 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4262 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4263 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4264 uses the name it is given.
4266 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4268 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4269 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4270 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4271 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4272 used, when there is no default.
4276 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4277 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4278 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4279 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4283 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4284 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4285 whatever that means.
4287 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4289 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4290 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4291 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4292 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4293 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4294 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4295 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4297 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4299 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4300 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4301 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4302 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4303 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4305 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4307 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4308 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4309 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4310 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4311 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4312 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4316 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4318 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4320 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4321 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4322 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4323 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4324 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4325 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4326 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4327 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4331 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4332 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4333 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4334 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4339 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4340 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4341 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4342 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4345 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4347 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4349 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4351 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4352 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4353 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4354 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4355 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4359 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4360 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4361 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4362 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4363 and &%-S%& options).
4365 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4366 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4367 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4368 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4369 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4370 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4373 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4374 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4375 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4376 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4377 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4380 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4381 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4382 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4383 this to be repeated periodically.
4385 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4386 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4387 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4388 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4390 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4391 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4392 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4394 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4395 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4396 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4397 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4401 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4402 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4403 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4404 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4405 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4406 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4409 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4410 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4411 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4412 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4413 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4414 delivered down a single SMTP
4415 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4416 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4417 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4418 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4419 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4422 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4424 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4425 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4426 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4427 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4428 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4430 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4432 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4433 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4434 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4435 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4436 their retry times are tried.
4438 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4440 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4441 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4444 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4446 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4447 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4448 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4451 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4452 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4453 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4454 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4455 starting message id. For example:
4457 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4459 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4460 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4461 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4463 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4465 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4466 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4467 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4468 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4469 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4470 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4472 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4473 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4474 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4475 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4476 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4477 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4478 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4479 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4480 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4482 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4484 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4485 process every 30 minutes.
4487 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4488 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4490 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4492 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4495 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4497 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4499 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4501 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4502 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4503 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4504 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4505 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4506 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4507 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4509 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4510 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4511 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4512 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4513 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4514 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4516 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4517 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4519 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4521 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4522 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4523 applied to each queue run.
4525 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4526 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4527 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4528 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4529 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4530 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4531 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4532 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4533 address will be skipped.
4535 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4536 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4537 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4540 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4541 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4542 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4543 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4544 an arbitrary command instead.
4548 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4550 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4552 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4553 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4554 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4555 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4556 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4557 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4559 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4561 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4562 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4563 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4567 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4568 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4569 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4570 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4571 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4572 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4573 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4574 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4575 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4577 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4578 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4579 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4580 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4581 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4582 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4583 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4584 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4585 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4586 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4587 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4589 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4590 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4591 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4592 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4593 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4594 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4596 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4597 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4598 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4599 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4600 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4601 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4602 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4603 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4604 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4608 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4609 compatibility with Sendmail.
4611 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4612 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4613 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4614 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4615 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4616 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4617 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4618 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4623 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4624 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4625 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4626 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4627 set. Exim ignores this option.
4631 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4632 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4633 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4634 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4635 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4636 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4641 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4642 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4643 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4646 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4648 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4649 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4651 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4653 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4654 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4655 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4663 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4664 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4665 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4666 . creates a man page for the options.
4667 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4670 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4677 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4678 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4681 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4682 "The runtime configuration file"
4684 .cindex "run time configuration"
4685 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4686 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4687 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4688 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4689 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4690 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4691 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4692 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4695 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4696 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4697 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4698 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4699 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4700 actually alter the string.
4702 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4703 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4704 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4705 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4706 existing file in the list.
4709 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4710 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4711 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4712 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4713 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4714 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4715 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4716 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4717 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4718 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4720 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4721 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4722 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4723 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4724 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4726 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4727 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4728 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4729 compromise the Exim user account.
4731 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4732 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4733 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4734 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4735 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4736 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4741 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4742 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4743 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4744 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4745 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4746 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4747 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4748 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4749 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4750 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4751 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4753 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4754 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4755 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4756 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4757 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4758 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4759 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4760 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4761 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4764 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4765 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4766 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4767 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4768 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4770 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4771 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4772 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4773 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4774 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4775 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4777 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4778 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4779 necessarily be discarded.
4780 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4781 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4782 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4783 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4784 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4785 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4787 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4788 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4789 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4790 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4791 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4792 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4793 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4795 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4796 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4797 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4801 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4802 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4803 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4804 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4805 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4806 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4807 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4811 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4814 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4815 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4816 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4818 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4819 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4820 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4822 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4823 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4824 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4826 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4827 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4828 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4829 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4832 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4833 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4834 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4836 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4837 want to use this feature, you must set
4839 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4841 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4842 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4845 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4846 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4847 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4848 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4850 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4851 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4852 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4853 and does not introduce a comment.
4855 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4856 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4857 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4858 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4859 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4861 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4862 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4863 change settings as required.
4865 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4866 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4867 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4868 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4869 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4874 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4875 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4876 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4877 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4878 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4879 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4882 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4883 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4885 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4886 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4887 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4890 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4891 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4892 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4893 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4895 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4896 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4899 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4902 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4903 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4908 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4909 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4910 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4911 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4912 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4913 definition, and must be of the form
4915 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4917 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4918 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4919 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4920 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4921 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4923 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4924 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4925 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4927 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4928 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4929 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4930 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4931 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4932 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4933 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4936 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4937 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4939 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4940 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4941 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4942 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4943 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4944 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4947 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4948 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4949 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4954 MAC == updated value
4956 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4957 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4958 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4959 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4963 MAC == MAC and something added
4965 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4966 from a number of other files.
4968 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4969 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4970 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4971 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4972 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4977 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4978 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4979 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4980 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4982 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4983 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4985 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4987 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4989 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4990 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4991 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4994 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4995 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4996 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4997 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4998 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4999 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5000 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5002 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5003 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5004 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5008 message_size_limit = 50M
5010 message_size_limit = 100M
5013 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
5014 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5015 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5016 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5018 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5019 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5020 in this line"& will always be true.
5022 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5023 to clarify complicated nestings.
5027 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5028 .cindex "common option syntax"
5029 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5030 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5031 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5032 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5033 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5034 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5035 space) and then the value. For example:
5037 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5039 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5040 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5041 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5042 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5043 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5044 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5045 word &"hide"&. For example:
5047 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5049 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5051 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5053 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5054 all instances of the same driver.
5056 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5057 that are found in option settings.
5060 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5061 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5062 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5063 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5064 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5065 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5066 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5067 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5068 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5069 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5070 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5071 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5076 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5081 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5086 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5087 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5088 .cindex "format" "integer"
5089 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5090 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5091 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5092 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5095 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5096 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5097 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5098 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5099 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5103 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5104 .cindex "integer format"
5105 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5106 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5107 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5108 Such options are always output in octal.
5111 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5112 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5113 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5114 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5115 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5119 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5120 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5121 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5122 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5123 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5133 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5134 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5135 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5139 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5140 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5141 .cindex "format" "string"
5142 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5143 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5144 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5145 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5146 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5147 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5148 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5149 therefore equivalent:
5151 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5152 trusted_users = uucp:\
5153 # This comment line is ignored
5156 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5157 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5158 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5159 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5160 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5163 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5164 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5165 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5167 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5168 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5172 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5173 character, that character replaces the pair.
5175 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5176 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5177 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5178 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5179 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5180 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5183 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5184 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5185 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5186 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5187 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5188 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5189 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5190 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5191 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5192 within a quoted configuration string.
5195 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5196 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5197 .cindex "format" "user name"
5198 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5199 .cindex "format" "group name"
5200 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5201 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5202 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5203 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5206 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5207 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5208 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5209 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5210 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5211 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5212 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5213 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5214 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5215 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5216 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5218 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5219 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5220 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5221 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5222 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5223 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5226 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5228 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5230 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5231 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5232 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5233 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5235 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5236 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5237 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5238 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5239 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5240 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5241 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5242 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5244 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5246 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5247 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5248 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5250 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5251 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5252 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5253 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5254 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5255 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5256 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5257 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5258 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5260 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5262 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5263 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5264 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5265 the value in quotes. For example:
5267 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5269 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5270 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5271 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5272 enclosing an empty list item.
5276 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5277 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5278 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5279 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5281 senders = user@domain :
5283 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5284 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5285 items, the second of which is empty:
5287 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5289 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5290 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5291 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5292 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5296 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5297 is at the end of the list.
5302 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5303 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5304 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5305 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5306 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5307 a sequence of lines like this:
5309 <&'instance name'&>:
5314 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5315 followed by three options settings:
5320 transport = local_delivery
5322 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5323 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5324 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5325 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5326 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5327 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5329 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5330 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5332 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5333 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5334 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5335 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5336 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5339 .cindex "generic options"
5340 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5341 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5342 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5343 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5344 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5345 .cindex "private options"
5346 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5347 they all have default values.
5349 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5350 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5351 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5353 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5354 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5355 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5356 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5357 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5358 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5359 configuration lines:
5364 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5365 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5366 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5367 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5373 command_timeout = 10s
5375 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5376 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5379 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5380 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5381 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5389 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5390 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5392 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5393 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5394 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5395 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5396 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5397 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5398 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5399 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5400 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5401 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5402 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5406 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5407 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5408 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5411 # primary_hostname =
5413 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5414 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5415 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5416 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5418 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5420 domainlist local_domains = @
5421 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5422 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5424 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5425 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5426 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5427 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5429 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5430 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5433 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5434 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5435 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5436 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5437 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5438 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5440 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5441 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5442 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5443 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5444 domain is permitted.
5446 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5447 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5448 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5449 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5450 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5451 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5453 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5454 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5455 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5457 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5459 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5460 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5462 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5463 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5464 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5465 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5466 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5467 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5468 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5469 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5470 contents of a message to be checked.
5472 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5474 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5475 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5477 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5478 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5479 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5480 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5482 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5484 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5485 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5486 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5488 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5489 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5490 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5491 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5492 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5493 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5494 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5496 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5498 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5499 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5501 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5502 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5503 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5504 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5505 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5506 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5507 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5508 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5509 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5510 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5511 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5512 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5513 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5514 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5515 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5516 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5518 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5521 # qualify_recipient =
5523 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5524 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5525 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5526 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5527 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5528 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5530 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5531 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5532 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5533 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5535 # allow_domain_literals
5537 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5538 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5539 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5540 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5541 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5542 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5544 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5548 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5549 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5550 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5551 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5552 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5553 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5554 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5555 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5557 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5558 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5563 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5564 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5565 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5566 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5567 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5568 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5571 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5572 1413 (hence their names):
5575 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5577 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5578 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5579 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5580 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5581 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5582 information, you can change this.
5584 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5585 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5590 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5591 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5592 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5593 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5595 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5596 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5598 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5599 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5601 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5604 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5605 +tls_certificate_verified
5608 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5610 # percent_hack_domains =
5612 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5613 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5614 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5616 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5617 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5618 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5619 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5620 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5621 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5622 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5623 always bounce messages.
5625 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5626 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5628 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5629 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5630 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5631 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5632 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5636 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5637 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5638 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5639 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5640 It starts with the line
5644 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5645 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5646 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5648 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5649 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5650 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5651 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5652 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5653 result of the ACL processing.
5657 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5662 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5663 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5664 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5665 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5666 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5667 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5669 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5670 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5671 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5674 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5675 domains = +local_domains
5676 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5678 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5679 domains = !+local_domains
5680 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5682 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5683 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5684 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5685 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5686 in Internet mail addresses.
5688 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5689 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5690 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5691 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5692 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5693 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5694 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5695 policy of being as safe as possible.
5697 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5698 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5699 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5700 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5701 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5702 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5704 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5705 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5706 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5707 have to modify this rule.
5709 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5710 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5711 common convention of local parts constructed as
5712 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5713 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5714 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5715 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5716 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5717 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5719 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5720 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5721 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5722 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5723 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5724 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5725 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5727 accept local_parts = postmaster
5728 domains = +local_domains
5730 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5731 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5732 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5733 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5734 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5736 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5737 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5738 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5740 require verify = sender
5742 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5743 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5744 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5745 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5746 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5747 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5748 discusses the details of address verification.
5750 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5751 control = submission
5753 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5754 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5755 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5756 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5757 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5758 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5759 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5760 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5761 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5763 accept authenticated = *
5764 control = submission
5766 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5767 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5768 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5769 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5770 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5771 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5773 require message = relay not permitted
5774 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5776 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5777 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5779 require verify = recipient
5781 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5782 fails, the address is rejected.
5784 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5785 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5787 # dnslists = black.list.example
5789 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5790 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5791 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5792 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5794 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5795 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5796 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5799 # require verify = csa
5801 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5802 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5807 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5808 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5812 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5813 of this ACL are commented out:
5816 # message = This message contains a virus \
5819 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5820 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5821 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5822 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5824 # warn spam = nobody
5825 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5826 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5827 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5828 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5830 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5831 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5832 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5833 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5834 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5835 whatever the spam score.
5839 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5842 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5843 .cindex "default" "routers"
5844 .cindex "routers" "default"
5845 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5850 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5851 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5852 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5853 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5854 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5857 # driver = ipliteral
5858 # domains = !+local_domains
5859 # transport = remote_smtp
5861 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5862 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5863 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5864 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5865 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5869 domains = ! +local_domains
5870 transport = remote_smtp
5871 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5874 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5875 domains. This is specified by the line
5877 domains = ! +local_domains
5879 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5880 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5881 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5882 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5883 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5884 passed on to the following routers.
5886 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5887 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5888 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5889 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5890 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5892 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5893 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5894 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5895 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5896 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5897 the address fails and is bounced.
5899 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5900 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5901 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5902 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5903 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5904 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5905 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5912 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5914 file_transport = address_file
5915 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5917 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5918 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5919 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5920 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5921 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5924 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5925 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5926 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5927 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5932 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5933 # local_part_suffix_optional
5934 file = $home/.forward
5939 file_transport = address_file
5940 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5941 reply_transport = address_reply
5943 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5944 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5945 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5946 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5947 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5950 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5951 # local_part_suffix_optional
5953 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5954 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5955 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5956 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5957 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5958 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5959 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5961 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5962 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5963 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5964 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5966 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5967 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5968 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5969 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5970 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5971 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5972 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5974 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5975 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5976 There are two reasons for doing this:
5979 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5980 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5983 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5984 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5985 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5986 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5990 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5991 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5992 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5993 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5995 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5996 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5997 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5999 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6001 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6007 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6008 # local_part_suffix_optional
6009 transport = local_delivery
6011 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6012 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6013 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6014 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6015 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6018 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6019 .cindex "default" "transports"
6020 .cindex "transports" "default"
6021 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6022 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6023 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6027 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6033 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6034 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6035 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6036 It is negotiated between client and server
6037 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6038 All other options are defaulted.
6042 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6049 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6050 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6051 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6052 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6053 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6054 show how this can be done.
6056 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6057 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6058 similarly-named options above.
6064 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6065 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6066 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
6075 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6076 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6077 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6082 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6087 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6088 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6089 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6090 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6091 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6092 introduced by the line
6096 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6099 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6101 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6102 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6103 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6104 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6106 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6107 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6108 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6111 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6112 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6116 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6117 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6121 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6122 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6123 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6125 begin authenticators
6127 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6128 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6129 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6130 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6131 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6132 to support most MUA software.
6134 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6137 # driver = plaintext
6138 # server_set_id = $auth2
6139 # server_prompts = :
6140 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6141 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6143 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6146 # driver = plaintext
6147 # server_set_id = $auth1
6148 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6149 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6150 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6153 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6154 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6155 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6156 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6157 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6158 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6159 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6160 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6162 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6163 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6164 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6165 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6167 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6168 usercode and password are in different positions.
6169 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6171 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6175 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6176 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6178 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6180 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6182 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6183 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6184 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6185 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6186 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6187 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6189 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6190 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6191 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6192 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6193 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6196 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6197 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6198 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6199 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6201 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6203 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6204 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6205 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6206 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6207 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6208 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6211 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6212 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6213 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6214 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6215 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6216 match anywhere in the subject string.
6218 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6219 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6221 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6223 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6226 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6228 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6229 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6233 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6234 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6236 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6237 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6238 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6239 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6240 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6241 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6244 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6245 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6246 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6247 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6248 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6250 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6251 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6252 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6253 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6254 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6257 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6258 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6259 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6260 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6261 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6262 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6264 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6265 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6266 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6267 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6268 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6270 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6271 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6273 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6274 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6275 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6276 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6277 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6279 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6280 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6282 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6283 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6285 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6286 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6287 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6292 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6293 matches the list item.
6295 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6296 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6298 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6300 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6301 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6302 causes a second lookup to occur.
6304 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6305 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6306 lookup is permitted.
6309 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6310 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6311 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6312 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6315 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6316 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6317 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6319 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6320 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6321 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6322 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6325 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6326 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6327 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6332 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6333 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6334 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6339 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6340 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6341 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6342 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6345 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6346 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6347 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6348 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6349 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6350 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6351 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6352 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6353 be found in several places:
6355 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6356 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6357 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6359 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6360 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6361 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6362 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6364 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6365 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6366 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6367 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6368 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6369 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6370 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6372 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6373 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6374 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6375 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6376 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6377 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6378 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6380 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6381 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6383 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6384 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6385 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6386 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6387 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6388 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6389 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6391 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6392 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6393 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6395 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6396 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6397 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6398 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6399 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6400 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6401 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6402 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6403 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6404 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6406 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6407 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6408 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6409 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6410 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6411 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6412 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6413 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6414 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6416 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6417 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6418 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6419 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6420 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6421 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6422 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6424 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6425 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6426 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6427 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6429 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6430 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6431 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6432 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6433 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6435 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6436 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6437 lookup types support only literal keys.
6439 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6440 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6441 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6443 .cindex "linear search"
6444 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6445 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6446 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6447 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6448 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6449 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6450 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6451 in the file is used.
6453 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6454 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6455 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6456 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6457 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6462 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6463 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6464 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6465 wildcarding of any kind.
6467 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6468 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6469 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6470 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6471 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6472 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6473 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6474 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6475 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6478 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6479 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6480 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6481 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6482 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6483 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6484 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6485 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6488 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6489 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6490 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6491 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6492 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6493 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6494 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6495 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6496 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6498 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6499 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6500 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6501 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6503 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6504 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6507 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6509 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6510 *fish data for anythingfish
6513 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6514 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6516 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6518 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6519 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6520 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6522 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6524 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6525 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6526 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6528 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6531 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6532 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6533 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6534 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6535 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6537 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6538 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6539 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6540 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6541 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6544 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6545 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6546 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6549 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6551 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6554 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6555 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6556 be followed by optional colons.
6558 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6559 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6560 lookup types support only literal keys.
6564 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6565 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6566 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6567 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6568 many of them are given in later sections.
6571 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6572 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6573 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6574 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6575 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6577 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6578 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6579 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6581 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6582 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6583 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6584 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6585 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6586 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6587 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6589 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6590 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6591 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6592 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6594 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6595 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6596 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6597 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6599 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6600 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6601 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6602 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6604 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6605 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6606 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6607 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6608 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6609 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6610 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6611 password value. For example:
6613 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6616 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6617 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6618 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6619 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6622 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6623 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6624 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6625 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6628 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6629 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6631 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6632 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6633 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6634 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6635 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6636 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6637 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6638 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6639 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6641 require condition = \
6642 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6644 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6645 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6646 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6647 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6652 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6653 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6654 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6655 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6656 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6657 options such as a list of local domains.
6659 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6660 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6661 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6662 or may give up altogether.
6666 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6667 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6668 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6669 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6670 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6671 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6672 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6673 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6675 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6676 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6677 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6679 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6680 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6681 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6683 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6684 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6685 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6686 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6687 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6688 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6689 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6690 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6691 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6692 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6694 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6696 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6697 looks up these keys, in this order:
6703 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6704 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6705 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6706 Exim move on to try the next key.
6710 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6711 .cindex "partial matching"
6712 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6713 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6714 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6715 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6716 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6717 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6718 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6719 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6720 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6721 a key in a DBM file is
6723 *.dates.fict.example
6725 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6726 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6727 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6730 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6731 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6732 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6734 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6735 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6736 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6737 partial matching keys
6738 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6739 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6740 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6742 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6743 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6744 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6745 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6746 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6747 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6750 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6751 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6752 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6753 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6754 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6755 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6757 2250.dates.fict.example
6758 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6759 *.dates.fict.example
6762 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6765 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6766 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6767 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6768 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6769 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6770 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6772 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6774 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6775 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6776 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6777 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6779 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6781 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6782 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6784 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6785 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6786 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6789 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6791 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6792 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6794 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6795 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6796 for &"*"& on its own.
6798 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6802 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6803 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6804 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6805 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6806 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6807 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6808 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6810 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6811 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6812 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6813 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6814 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6819 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6820 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6821 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6822 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6823 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6824 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6825 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6827 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6828 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6829 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6830 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6831 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6832 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6834 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6835 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6841 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6842 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6843 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6844 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6845 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6846 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6850 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6851 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6853 [name="$local_part"]
6855 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6856 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6857 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6858 of the following form is provided:
6860 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6862 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6864 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6866 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6867 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6868 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6873 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6874 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6875 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6876 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6877 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6878 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6879 an expansion string could contain:
6881 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6883 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6884 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6885 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6886 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6888 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
6889 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
6890 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
6892 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
6893 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6894 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6895 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6896 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6898 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6900 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6901 white space is ignored.
6902 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
6903 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
6904 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
6906 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6907 When the type is PTR,
6908 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6909 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6911 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6913 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6914 altered and nothing is added.
6916 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6917 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6918 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6919 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6920 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6921 The field separator can be modified as above.
6923 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6924 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6925 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6926 unless a field separator is specified.
6927 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6929 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6931 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6932 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6933 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6935 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6936 white space is ignored.
6938 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6939 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
6940 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
6941 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
6944 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
6947 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
6948 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
6949 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
6950 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
6951 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are givien by optional keywords,
6952 each followed by a comma,
6953 that may appear before the record type.
6955 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6956 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6957 a defer-option modifier.
6958 The possible keywords are
6959 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
6960 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6961 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6962 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6963 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6964 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6965 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6967 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6968 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6970 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6971 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6973 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
6974 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
6975 The possible keywords are
6976 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
6977 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
6979 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
6980 is not labelled as authenticated data
6981 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
6982 The default is &"never"&.
6984 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
6986 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
6987 .cindex "DNS" timeout
6988 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
6989 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
6991 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
6993 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
6994 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
6995 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
6998 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6999 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7000 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7001 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7002 the pseudo-type MXH:
7004 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7006 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7009 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7010 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7011 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7012 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7013 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7014 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7015 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7016 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7018 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7019 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7021 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7022 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7023 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7025 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7026 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7027 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7028 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7029 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7032 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7033 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7034 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7035 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7036 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7037 result of a successful lookup such as:
7039 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7041 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7042 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7043 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7045 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7046 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7047 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7048 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7050 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7054 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7055 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7056 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7057 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7058 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7060 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7061 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7062 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7064 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7065 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7066 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7067 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7069 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7070 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7071 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7076 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7077 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7078 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7079 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7080 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7081 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7082 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7083 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7084 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7085 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7086 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7087 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7089 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7090 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7091 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7092 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7093 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7095 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7096 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7098 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7099 the way they handle the results of a query:
7102 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7105 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7106 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7108 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7109 from all of them are returned.
7113 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7114 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7115 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7116 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7119 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7120 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7121 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7122 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7124 data = ${lookup ldap \
7125 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7126 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7128 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7129 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7130 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7131 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7133 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7134 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7135 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7137 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7138 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7139 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7140 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7141 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7142 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7143 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7144 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7148 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7149 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7150 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7151 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7152 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7153 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7155 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7156 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7164 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7165 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7169 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7171 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7175 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7177 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7179 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7181 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7182 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7183 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7187 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7188 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7189 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7191 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7195 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7197 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7199 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7201 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7202 authentication below.
7205 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7206 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7207 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7208 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7209 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7212 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7214 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7215 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7216 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7217 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7218 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7219 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7220 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7221 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7222 failures, and timeouts.
7224 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7225 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7226 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7227 doubled. For example
7229 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7231 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7232 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7233 the local host) is used.
7235 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7236 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7237 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7238 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7241 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7242 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7243 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7244 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7246 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7248 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7249 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7251 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7253 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7254 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7255 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7256 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7257 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7258 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7259 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7262 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7263 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7264 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7267 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7270 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7274 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7275 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7279 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7280 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7281 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7282 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7283 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7284 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7285 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7286 them. The following names are recognized:
7288 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7289 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7290 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7291 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7292 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7293 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7294 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7295 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7297 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7298 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7299 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7300 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7302 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7303 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7304 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7305 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7306 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7307 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7308 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7309 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7310 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7312 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7313 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7315 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7316 to use for an individual lookup. The global ldap_servers option provides a
7317 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7318 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7319 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7320 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7321 alternate list (colon-separated).
7323 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7324 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7327 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7328 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7331 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7332 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7333 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7334 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7336 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7337 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7338 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7340 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7341 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7342 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7343 quoting has two advantages:
7346 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7347 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7349 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7352 For example, a setting such as
7354 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7356 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7358 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7359 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7360 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7361 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7365 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7366 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7371 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7372 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7373 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7374 as a sequence of values, for example
7376 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7378 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7379 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7380 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7381 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7382 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7385 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7386 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7387 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7389 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7390 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7391 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7392 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7393 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7394 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7395 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7396 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7397 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7399 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7400 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7401 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7402 &%attr2%& has only one value:
7404 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7407 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7410 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7411 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7413 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7414 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7417 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7418 results of LDAP lookups.
7419 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7420 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7421 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7422 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7423 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7424 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7429 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7430 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7431 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7432 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7433 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7434 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7435 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7436 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7438 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7440 might return the string
7442 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7443 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7445 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7447 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7453 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7454 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7455 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7459 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7460 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7461 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7462 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7463 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7464 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7465 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7466 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7467 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7468 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7469 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7470 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7473 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7476 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7477 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7479 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7484 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7486 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7487 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7488 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7492 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7493 with a newline between the data for each row.
7496 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7497 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7498 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7499 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7500 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7501 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7502 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7503 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7504 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7505 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7506 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7507 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7509 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7510 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7511 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7512 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7513 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7514 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7516 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7518 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7519 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7520 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7522 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7523 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7525 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7526 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7527 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7528 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7529 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7530 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7532 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7533 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7534 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7535 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7536 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7537 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7538 characters are not special.
7540 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7541 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7542 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7543 done by starting the query with
7545 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7547 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7549 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7550 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7551 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7554 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7556 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7557 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7558 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7560 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7561 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7562 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7565 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7569 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7571 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7573 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7574 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7575 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7577 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7581 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7582 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7583 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7584 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7585 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7587 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7588 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7590 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7591 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7593 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7596 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7597 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7599 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7600 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7601 is zero because no rows are affected.
7604 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7605 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7606 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7607 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7608 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7611 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7613 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7614 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7615 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7617 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7618 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7621 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7622 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7623 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7624 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7625 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7626 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7627 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7628 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7629 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7631 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7632 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7634 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7636 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7637 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7639 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7640 quote, which it doubles.
7642 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7643 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7644 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7645 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7646 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7647 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7653 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7654 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7656 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7657 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7658 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7659 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7660 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7661 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7662 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7663 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7664 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7666 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7667 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7668 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7669 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7673 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7674 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7675 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7676 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7677 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7678 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7679 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7680 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7683 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7684 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7685 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7687 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7688 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7689 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7690 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7691 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7693 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7694 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7696 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7697 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7698 senders based on the receiving domain.
7703 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7704 .cindex "list" "negation"
7705 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7706 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7707 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7708 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7709 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7710 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7712 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7713 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7714 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7715 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7716 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7718 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7720 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7721 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7722 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7724 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7726 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7727 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7728 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7730 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7731 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7736 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7737 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7738 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7739 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7740 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7741 file names are not allowed,
7742 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7743 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7747 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7748 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7750 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7751 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7752 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7754 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7758 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7759 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7760 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7761 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7763 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7764 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7766 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7768 and the file contains the lines
7773 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7774 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7778 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7779 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7780 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7781 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7782 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7783 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7784 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7785 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7787 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7788 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7789 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7790 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7795 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7796 .cindex "named lists"
7797 .cindex "list" "named"
7798 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7799 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7800 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7801 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7802 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7803 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7804 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7806 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7808 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7809 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7810 configured with the line
7812 domains = +local_domains
7814 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7815 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7819 domains = ! +local_domains
7820 transport = remote_smtp
7823 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7824 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7825 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7826 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7828 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7829 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7831 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7833 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7834 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7835 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7837 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7838 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7839 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7841 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7842 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7844 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7845 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7846 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7848 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7850 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7851 referenced lists if you can.
7853 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7854 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7855 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7857 domains = +local_domains
7859 on several of your routers
7860 or in several ACL statements,
7861 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7862 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7863 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7864 the same each time they are referenced.
7866 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7867 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7868 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7869 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7873 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7874 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7875 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7876 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7877 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7880 ALIST = host1 : host2
7881 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7883 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7885 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7887 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7890 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7891 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7893 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7895 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7899 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7900 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7901 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7902 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7903 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7904 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7905 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7906 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7907 message. For example:
7909 domainlist special_domains = \
7910 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7912 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7913 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7914 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7915 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7916 same list each time.
7918 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7919 cache the result anyway. For example:
7921 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7923 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7924 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7928 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7929 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7930 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7931 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7932 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7935 .cindex "primary host name"
7936 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7937 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7938 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7939 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7940 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7941 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7942 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7943 differ only in their names.
7945 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7946 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7947 .cindex "domain literal"
7948 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7949 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7950 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7951 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7952 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7953 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7956 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7957 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7958 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7959 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7960 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7961 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7962 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7963 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7964 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7965 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7966 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7968 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7969 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7970 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7971 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7972 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7974 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7975 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7976 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7977 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7978 on a router). For example:
7980 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7982 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7983 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7985 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7986 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7987 contain negative items.
7989 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7990 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7991 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7993 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7994 an.other.domain : ...
7996 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7997 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7999 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8000 an.other.domain ? ...
8003 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8004 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8005 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8006 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8007 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8008 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8009 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8010 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8011 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8015 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8016 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8017 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8018 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8019 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8020 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8021 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8022 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8023 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8025 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8026 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8027 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8028 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8029 expression by expansion, of course).
8031 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8032 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8033 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8034 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8035 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8036 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8038 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8040 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8041 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8042 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8043 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8044 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8045 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8046 other statements in the same ACL.
8049 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8050 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8052 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8054 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8055 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8058 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8059 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8060 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8061 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8062 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8063 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8066 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8067 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8068 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8069 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8071 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8072 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8074 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8075 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8076 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8077 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8078 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8080 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8081 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8082 between the pattern and the domain.
8085 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8087 domainlist funny_domains = \
8090 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8091 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8092 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8093 nis;domains.byname : \
8094 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8096 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8097 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8098 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8099 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8100 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8105 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8106 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8107 .cindex "list" "host list"
8108 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8109 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8110 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8111 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8112 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8113 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8114 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8117 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8118 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8119 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8120 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8121 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8122 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8125 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8126 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8127 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8131 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8132 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8133 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8134 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8135 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8136 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8137 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8140 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8141 inspecting its IP address:
8144 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8145 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8146 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8147 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8148 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8149 with the IP address of the subject host.
8151 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8152 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8153 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8154 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8155 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8158 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8159 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8160 domain name, as just described.
8163 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8164 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8165 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8166 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8167 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8168 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8169 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8170 that can never match a client host.
8173 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8174 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8175 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8176 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8178 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8182 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8183 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8184 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8185 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8186 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8187 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8188 significant end of the address.
8190 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8191 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8192 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8193 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8197 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8198 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8201 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8203 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8204 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8206 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8207 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8210 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8212 could make use of a file containing
8217 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8218 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8219 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8221 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8224 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8230 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8231 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8232 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8233 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8234 address, the pattern takes this form:
8236 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8240 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8242 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8243 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8244 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8245 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8246 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8247 returned by the lookup is not used.
8249 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8250 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8251 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8252 patterns of this form:
8254 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8258 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8260 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8261 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8262 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8263 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8264 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8266 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8267 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8268 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8269 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8270 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8271 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8272 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8273 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8274 addresses are always used.
8276 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8277 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8278 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8281 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8282 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8283 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8284 case the IP address is used on its own.
8288 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8289 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8290 .cindex "unknown host name"
8291 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8292 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8293 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8294 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8295 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8298 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8299 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8300 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8301 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8302 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8303 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8304 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8306 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8307 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8309 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8310 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8311 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8312 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8313 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8314 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8315 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8316 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8317 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8319 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8320 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8322 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8323 .cindex "alias for host"
8324 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8325 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8328 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8329 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8330 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8331 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8332 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8335 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8336 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8337 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8338 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8339 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8340 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8341 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8346 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8347 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8348 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8349 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8350 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8352 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8354 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8355 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8356 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8363 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8364 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8365 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8366 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8367 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8368 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8370 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8371 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8373 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8374 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8375 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8376 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8377 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8378 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8379 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8380 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8381 not recognized in an indirected file).
8384 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8385 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8387 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8389 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8390 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8393 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8394 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8397 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8400 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8401 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8402 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8405 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8406 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8409 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8411 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8413 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8414 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8415 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8418 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8419 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8420 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8422 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8424 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8425 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8426 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8427 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8428 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8429 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8430 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8433 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8434 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8436 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8437 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8439 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8440 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8441 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8446 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8448 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8449 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8450 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8451 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8452 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8453 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8454 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8455 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8456 host lists such as whitelists.
8460 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8461 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8462 .cindex "unknown host name"
8463 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8464 If a pattern is of the form
8466 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8470 dbm;/host/accept/list
8472 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8473 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8476 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8477 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8478 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8479 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8480 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8481 lookup, both using the same file.
8485 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8486 If a pattern is of the form
8488 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8490 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8491 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8492 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8494 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8495 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8497 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8498 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8499 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8502 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8503 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8504 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8506 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8507 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8508 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8509 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8510 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8511 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8517 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8518 .cindex "list" "address list"
8519 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8520 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8521 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8522 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8523 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8524 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8525 using this option setting:
8529 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8530 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8531 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8532 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8534 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8537 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8539 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8540 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8541 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8542 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8543 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8544 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8545 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8547 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8548 *@+hostile_domains:\
8549 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8550 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8552 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8553 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8554 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8555 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8556 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8558 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8559 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8560 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8561 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8562 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8564 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8567 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8568 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8572 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8573 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8574 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8575 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8576 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8577 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8578 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8580 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8581 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8583 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8584 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8587 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8588 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8589 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8592 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8593 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8594 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8596 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8597 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8598 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8599 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8601 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8602 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8604 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8605 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8606 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8607 default. For example, with this lookup:
8609 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8611 the file could contains lines like this:
8613 user1@domain1.example
8616 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8619 nimrod@jaeger.example
8623 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8624 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8626 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8628 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8629 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8631 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8632 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8633 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8637 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8638 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8643 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8644 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8645 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8646 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8647 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8648 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8649 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8650 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8651 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8653 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8654 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8655 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8656 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8657 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8660 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8662 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8664 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8666 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8668 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8669 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8670 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8671 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8672 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8673 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8675 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8678 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8681 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8682 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8683 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8684 might have entries like
8686 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8687 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8690 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8691 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8692 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8693 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8695 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8696 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8697 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8700 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8701 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8702 can only return a single list of local parts.
8705 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8706 in these two examples:
8709 senders = *@+my_list
8711 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8712 example it is a named domain list.
8717 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8718 .cindex "case of local parts"
8719 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8720 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8721 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8722 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8723 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8724 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8725 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8726 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8729 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8730 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8731 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8732 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8733 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8734 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8735 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8738 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8739 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8740 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8741 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8742 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8743 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8744 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8745 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8749 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8750 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8751 .cindex "local part" "list"
8752 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8753 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8754 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8755 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8756 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8757 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8758 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8759 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8761 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8762 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8763 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8764 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8765 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8766 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8767 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8769 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8774 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8775 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8777 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8778 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8779 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8780 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8782 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8783 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8784 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8785 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8786 escape character, as described in the following section.
8788 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8789 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8790 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
8791 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8792 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8797 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8798 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8799 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8800 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8801 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8802 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8803 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8804 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8806 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8807 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8808 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8809 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8811 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8813 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8814 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8819 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8820 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8821 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8822 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8823 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8824 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8825 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8828 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8829 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8830 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8833 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8834 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8835 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8837 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8838 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8839 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8840 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8841 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8842 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8843 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8846 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8847 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8848 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8851 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8852 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8853 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8854 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8856 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8858 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8859 Exim message identifier. For example:
8861 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8863 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8864 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8867 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8868 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8869 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8870 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8871 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8872 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8873 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8874 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8875 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8876 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8877 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8878 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8884 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8885 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8886 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8887 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8888 white space is significant.
8891 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8892 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8893 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8898 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8899 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8900 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8901 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8902 given, the expansion fails.
8904 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8905 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8906 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8907 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8911 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8912 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8913 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8914 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8915 string easier to understand.
8917 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8918 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8919 expansion item below.
8922 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8923 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8924 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8925 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8926 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8927 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8928 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8929 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8930 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8931 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8932 the result of the expansion.
8933 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8934 the expansion result is an empty string.
8935 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8938 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
8939 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8940 .cindex "expansion" "extracting cerificate fields"
8941 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
8942 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
8943 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
8944 The field name is expanded and used to retrive the relevant field from
8945 the certificate. Supported fields are:
8949 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
8950 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
8955 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
8959 If the field is found,
8960 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8961 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8962 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8963 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8965 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8966 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8969 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
8971 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
8972 output a Distinguished Name string which is
8974 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
8975 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
8976 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
8977 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
8978 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
8979 The separator may be changed by another modifer of
8980 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
8981 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
8983 The field selectors marked as "time" above
8984 take an optional modifier of "int"
8985 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
8986 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
8987 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
8989 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
8990 newline-separated by default,
8991 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
8992 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
8993 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
8995 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
8996 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
8997 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
8998 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
8999 if so the elenment tags are omitted.
9001 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9003 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9004 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9006 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9007 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9011 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9012 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9013 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9015 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9016 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9017 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9018 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9019 must have the following type:
9021 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9023 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9024 function should return one of the following values:
9026 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9027 into the expanded string that is being built.
9029 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9030 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9032 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9033 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9035 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9037 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9038 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9039 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9042 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9043 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9044 .cindex "environment" "value from"
9045 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9047 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9048 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9049 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9051 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9052 appear, for example:
9054 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9056 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9057 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9059 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9061 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9065 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9066 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9067 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9068 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9069 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9070 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9071 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
9074 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9077 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9078 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9079 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9080 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9081 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9082 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9083 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9084 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9085 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9087 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9088 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9089 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9092 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9093 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9095 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9096 appear, for example:
9098 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9100 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9101 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9104 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9105 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9106 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9107 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9108 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9109 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9110 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9111 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9112 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9113 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9114 <&'string3'&> as before.
9116 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9117 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9118 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9119 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9120 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9121 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9122 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9123 provided. For example:
9125 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9129 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9131 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9132 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9135 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9136 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9137 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9139 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9140 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9141 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9142 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9143 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9144 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9145 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9147 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9149 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9150 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9153 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9154 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9155 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9156 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9157 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9158 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9160 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9161 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9162 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9163 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9165 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9167 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9168 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9169 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9170 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9171 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9173 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9175 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9176 letters appear. For example:
9178 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9179 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9180 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9183 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9184 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9185 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9186 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9187 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9188 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9189 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9190 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9191 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9192 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9193 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9194 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9195 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9196 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9200 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9201 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9202 lines) may be present.
9204 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9205 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9208 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9209 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9210 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9213 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9214 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9215 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9216 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9217 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9218 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9219 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9220 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9223 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9224 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9225 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9226 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9227 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9228 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9231 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9232 command of the following form:
9234 headers charset "UTF-8"
9236 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9237 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9238 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9239 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9240 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9243 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9244 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9245 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9246 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9248 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9249 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9250 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9251 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9252 router or transport are not accessible.
9254 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9255 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9256 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9257 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9258 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9259 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9261 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9262 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9263 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9264 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
9265 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
9266 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
9267 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
9269 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9270 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9271 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9272 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9273 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9274 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9275 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9276 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9279 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9280 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9282 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9283 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9284 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9285 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9286 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9287 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9288 present. For example:
9290 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9292 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9295 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9297 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9298 an Exim configuration:
9300 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9302 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9305 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9306 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9307 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9309 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9310 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9311 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9312 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9313 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9314 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9317 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9318 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9319 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9320 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9321 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9322 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9324 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9326 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9327 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9328 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9329 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9330 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9332 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9333 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9334 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9336 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9340 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9343 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9344 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9345 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9346 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9347 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9348 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9349 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9352 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9354 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9355 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9356 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9359 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9360 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9361 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9362 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9363 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9364 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9365 apart from an optional leading minus,
9366 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9368 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9369 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9371 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9372 If the number is negative, the fields are
9373 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9374 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9375 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9377 If the modulus of the
9378 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9379 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9383 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9387 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9389 yields &"result: 99"&.
9391 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9392 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9394 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9397 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9398 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9399 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9400 described in the next item.
9402 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9403 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9404 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9405 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9406 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9407 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9408 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9409 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9410 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9412 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9413 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9414 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9415 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9416 out by the system administrator.
9419 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9420 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9421 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9422 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9423 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9424 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9425 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9426 original lookup fails.
9428 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9429 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9430 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9431 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9432 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9433 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9434 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9435 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9437 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9438 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9439 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9440 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9442 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9443 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9444 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9445 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9447 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9449 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9451 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9452 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9454 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9459 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9460 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9462 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9463 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9464 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9465 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9466 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9467 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9469 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9471 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9472 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9473 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9475 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9476 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9477 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9478 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9479 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9480 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9481 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9483 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9485 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9486 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9487 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9488 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9491 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9493 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9497 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9498 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9499 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9500 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9501 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9502 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9503 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9504 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9506 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9507 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9508 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9509 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9510 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9513 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9514 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9515 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9517 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9518 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9521 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9522 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9523 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9524 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9525 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9526 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9527 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9528 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9530 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9531 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9532 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9533 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9534 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9535 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9536 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9537 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9538 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9539 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9541 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9542 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9543 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9544 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9546 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9547 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9548 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9549 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9550 is the expansion of the third argument.
9552 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9553 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9554 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9556 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9557 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9558 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9559 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9560 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9561 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9562 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9563 newlines are left in the string.
9564 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9565 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9566 the string expansion fails.
9568 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9569 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9573 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9574 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9575 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9576 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9577 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9578 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9579 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9582 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9583 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9585 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9586 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9587 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9588 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9589 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9592 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9594 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9595 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9596 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9597 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9598 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9599 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9601 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9603 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9604 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9605 turns them into spaces:
9607 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9609 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9610 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9611 addition, the following errors can occur:
9614 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9616 Failure to connect the socket;
9618 Failure to write the request string;
9620 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9623 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9624 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9625 errors occurs. For example:
9627 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9630 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9631 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9632 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9633 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9634 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9636 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9637 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9640 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9641 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9642 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9645 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9646 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9647 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9648 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9649 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9650 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9651 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9652 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9653 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9655 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9657 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9660 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9662 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9663 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9666 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9667 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9668 expansion item above.
9670 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9671 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9672 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9673 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9674 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9675 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9676 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9677 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9678 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9680 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9681 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9682 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9683 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9684 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9685 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9686 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9687 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9688 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9691 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9692 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9693 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9695 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9696 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9697 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9698 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9699 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9702 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9703 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9704 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9705 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9707 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9708 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9709 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9712 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9713 log_message = Output of id: $value
9715 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9716 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9718 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9722 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9723 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9725 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9726 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9730 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9731 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9734 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9735 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9736 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9737 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9739 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9740 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9743 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9744 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9745 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9746 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9747 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9748 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9749 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9750 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9752 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9754 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9755 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9756 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9758 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9760 yields &"defabc"&, and
9762 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9764 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9765 the regular expression from string expansion.
9769 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9770 .cindex sorting "a list"
9771 .cindex list sorting
9772 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
9773 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9774 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9775 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9776 of a two-argument expansion condition.
9777 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9778 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9779 if the first value should sort before the second value.
9780 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9781 the element being placed in &$item$&,
9782 to give values for comparison.
9784 The item result is a sorted list,
9785 with the original list separator,
9786 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9790 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
9792 sorts a list of numbers, and
9794 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
9796 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
9799 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9800 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9801 .cindex "substring extraction"
9802 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9803 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9804 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9805 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9806 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9808 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9810 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9811 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9814 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9815 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9816 length required. For example
9818 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9820 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9821 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9822 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9823 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9825 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9826 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9827 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9829 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9831 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9832 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9833 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9835 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9837 yields an empty string, but
9839 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9843 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9844 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9845 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9846 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9849 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9851 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9855 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9856 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9857 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9858 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9859 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9860 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9861 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9862 replacement list. For example
9864 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9866 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9867 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9868 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9874 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9875 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9876 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9877 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9878 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9879 following operations can be performed:
9882 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9883 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9884 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9885 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9886 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9887 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9890 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9891 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9892 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9893 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9894 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9895 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9896 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9897 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9898 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9900 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9901 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9902 character. For example:
9904 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9906 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9907 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9908 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9911 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9912 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9913 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9914 email address seperator. For the example header line:
9916 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9918 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9919 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9920 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9921 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9922 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9923 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9926 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9927 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9929 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9930 Last:user@example.com
9931 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9935 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9936 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9937 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9938 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9939 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9940 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9941 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9942 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9943 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9945 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9946 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9947 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9948 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9949 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9950 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9954 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9955 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9956 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9957 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9958 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9961 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9962 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9963 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9964 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9965 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9966 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9967 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9970 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9971 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9972 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9973 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9974 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9975 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9976 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9977 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9978 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9979 C programming language):
9981 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9982 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9983 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9984 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9987 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9989 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9990 space is permitted before or after operators.
9992 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9993 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9994 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9995 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9996 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9998 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10000 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10001 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10004 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10005 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10006 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10007 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10008 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
10009 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10010 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10011 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10012 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10013 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
10014 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10017 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10019 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10022 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10025 {$recipients_count} \
10026 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10030 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10031 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10034 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10035 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10036 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10039 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10041 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10042 and then re-expands what it has found.
10045 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10047 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10048 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10049 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10050 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10051 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10052 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10053 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10054 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10055 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10057 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10058 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10059 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10060 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10061 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10062 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10063 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10066 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10067 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10068 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10069 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10070 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10071 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10073 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10075 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10076 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10080 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10081 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10082 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10083 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10084 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10085 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10089 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10090 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10091 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10092 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10093 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10094 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10095 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10098 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10099 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10100 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10101 .cindex "lower casing"
10102 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10103 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10104 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10109 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10110 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10111 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10112 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10113 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10114 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10116 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10118 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10119 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10120 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10123 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10124 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10125 .cindex "list" "item count"
10126 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10127 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10128 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10131 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10132 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10133 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10134 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10135 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10136 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10137 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10138 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10139 matching list is returned.
10142 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10143 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10144 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10145 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10146 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10150 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10151 .cindex "masked IP address"
10152 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10153 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10154 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10155 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10156 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10157 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10158 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10159 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10160 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10162 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10164 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10165 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10166 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10167 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10169 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10173 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10175 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10178 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10180 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10181 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10182 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10183 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10184 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10187 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10188 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10189 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10190 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10191 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10192 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10194 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10196 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10199 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10200 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10201 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10202 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10203 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10204 is an empty string or
10205 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10206 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10207 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10208 respectively For example,
10216 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10217 variable or a message header.
10219 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10220 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10221 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10222 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10223 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10224 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10225 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10228 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10229 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10230 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10231 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10232 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10234 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10240 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10241 yields an unchanged string.
10244 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10245 .cindex "random number"
10246 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10247 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10248 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10249 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10250 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10251 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10252 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10253 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10257 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10258 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10259 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10260 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
10261 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10262 for DNS. For example,
10264 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10265 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10270 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10274 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10275 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10276 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10277 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10278 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10279 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10280 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10281 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
10282 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10285 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10287 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10288 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10292 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10293 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10294 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10295 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10296 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10297 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10298 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10299 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10301 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10302 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10303 to use this operator as well.
10307 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10308 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10309 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10310 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10311 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10312 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10313 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10316 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10317 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10318 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10319 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10320 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10321 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10322 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10325 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'certificate'&>&*}*&
10326 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10327 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10328 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10329 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10330 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the
10333 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10334 Only arguments which are a single variable of certificate type are supported.
10337 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10338 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10339 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10340 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10341 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10342 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10343 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10344 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10345 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10346 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10347 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10348 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10349 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10351 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10352 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10353 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10355 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10356 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10357 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10358 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10359 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10363 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10364 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10365 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10366 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10367 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10368 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10371 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10372 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10373 .cindex "substring extraction"
10374 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10375 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10376 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10377 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10379 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10381 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10382 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10384 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10385 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10386 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10387 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10390 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10391 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10392 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10393 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10394 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10395 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10398 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10399 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10400 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10401 .cindex "upper casing"
10402 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10403 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10404 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10406 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10407 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10408 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10409 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10410 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10411 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10412 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10420 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10421 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10422 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10423 while expanding strings:
10426 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10427 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10428 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10429 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10432 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10433 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10434 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10435 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10441 &`>= `& greater or equal
10443 &`<= `& less or equal
10447 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10449 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10450 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10451 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10452 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10453 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10456 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10457 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10458 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10461 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10462 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10463 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10464 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10465 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10466 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10467 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10468 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10469 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10470 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10471 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10472 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10473 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10474 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10476 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10477 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10478 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10479 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10480 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10481 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10483 An empty string is treated as false.
10484 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10485 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10486 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10488 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10489 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10492 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10496 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10497 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10498 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10499 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10500 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10501 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10502 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10503 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10505 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10507 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10508 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10509 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10510 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10511 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10512 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10513 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10514 included in the binary.
10516 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10517 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10518 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10519 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10520 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10521 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10522 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10523 string in LDAP form is:
10525 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10527 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10528 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10530 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10532 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10537 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10538 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10539 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10540 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10541 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10542 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10546 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10547 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10548 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10549 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10550 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10551 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10554 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10555 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10556 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10557 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10558 whatever its length.
10561 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10562 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10563 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10564 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10566 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10567 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10568 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10569 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10570 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10571 support &[crypt16()]&.
10573 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10574 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10575 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10576 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10577 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10579 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10580 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10581 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10583 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10584 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10585 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10586 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10587 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10589 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10590 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10591 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10592 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10593 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10594 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10596 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10598 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10599 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10601 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10602 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10603 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10604 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10605 exists in the message. For example,
10607 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10609 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10610 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10612 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10613 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10614 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10615 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10616 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10617 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10618 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10619 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10620 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10622 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10623 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10624 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10625 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10626 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10627 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10628 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10629 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10631 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10632 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10633 .cindex "first delivery"
10634 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10635 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10636 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10637 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10640 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10641 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10642 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10643 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10644 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10646 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10647 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10648 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10649 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10650 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10652 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10653 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10654 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10656 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10657 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10658 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10660 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10661 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10662 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10663 list separator is changed to a comma:
10665 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10667 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10668 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10670 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10673 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10674 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10675 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10676 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10677 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10678 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10679 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10680 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10681 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10684 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10685 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10686 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10687 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10688 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10689 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10690 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10691 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10692 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10695 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10696 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10697 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10698 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10699 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10700 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10703 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10704 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10706 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10707 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10708 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10709 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10712 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10713 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10714 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10715 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10716 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10717 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10718 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10719 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10720 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10721 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10722 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10724 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10725 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10726 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10727 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10728 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10730 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10731 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10732 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10733 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10735 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10737 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10739 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10740 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10741 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10742 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10743 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10744 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10745 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10746 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10747 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10748 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10749 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10750 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10751 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10755 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10756 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10757 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10758 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10759 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10760 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10761 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10762 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10763 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10766 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10767 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10768 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10769 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10770 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10771 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10772 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10773 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10774 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10778 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10779 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10780 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10781 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10782 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10783 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10784 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10785 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10786 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10787 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10788 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10791 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10793 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10794 backslashes is also required.
10796 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10797 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10798 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10799 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10800 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10801 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10803 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10804 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10805 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10806 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10807 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10808 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10809 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10810 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10812 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10813 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10814 See &*match_local_part*&.
10816 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10817 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10818 See &*match_local_part*&.
10820 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10821 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10822 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10823 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10824 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10825 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10827 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10829 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10832 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10834 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10836 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10837 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10838 in a single test such as
10839 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10840 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10841 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10842 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10844 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10846 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10848 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10850 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10851 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10852 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10853 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10854 masks. For example:
10856 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10858 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10859 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10860 address mask, for example:
10862 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10864 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10865 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10867 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10871 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10872 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10874 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10876 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10877 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10878 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10879 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10880 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10881 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10882 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10883 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10886 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10888 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10889 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10890 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10891 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10893 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10895 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10896 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10897 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10898 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10901 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10902 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10904 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10905 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10906 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10907 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10909 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10910 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10911 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10912 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10913 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10914 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10915 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10916 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10917 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10918 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10919 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10923 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10924 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10926 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10927 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10928 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10929 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10930 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10931 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10932 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10934 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10935 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10936 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10937 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10938 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10940 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10942 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10944 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10946 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10947 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10948 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10949 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10950 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10951 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10952 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10953 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10956 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10957 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10959 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10960 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10961 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10962 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10963 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10964 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10966 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10967 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10968 building Exim. For example:
10970 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10972 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10973 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10974 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10975 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10977 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10978 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10979 configuration, you might have this:
10981 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10983 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10985 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10987 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10988 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10989 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10990 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10991 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10992 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10995 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10997 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10998 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10999 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11000 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11001 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11004 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11005 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11006 this library, you need to set
11008 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11010 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11011 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11013 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11015 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11016 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11017 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11019 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11020 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11021 the authentication is successful. For example:
11023 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11027 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11028 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11029 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11031 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11032 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11033 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11034 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11035 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11036 by a process that is not running as root.
11038 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11039 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11040 building Exim. For example:
11042 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11044 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11045 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11046 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11048 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11049 two are mandatory. For example:
11051 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11053 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11054 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11055 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11060 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11061 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11062 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11063 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11064 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11065 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11066 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11070 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11071 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11072 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11073 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11074 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11077 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11079 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11080 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11081 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11083 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11084 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11085 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11086 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11087 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11088 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11089 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11090 parsed but not evaluated.
11092 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11097 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11098 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11099 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11100 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11101 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11104 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11105 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11106 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11107 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11108 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11109 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11110 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11111 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11112 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11113 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11114 matching condition.
11116 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11117 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11118 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11119 any unused variables being made empty.
11121 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11122 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11123 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11124 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11125 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11126 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11127 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11128 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11129 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11130 during subsequent delivery.
11132 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11133 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11134 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11135 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11136 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11137 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11138 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11139 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11142 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11143 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11144 this variable has the number of arguments.
11146 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11147 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11148 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11149 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11150 be preserved by coding like this:
11152 warn !verify = sender
11153 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11155 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11156 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11159 .vitem &$address_data$&
11160 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11161 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11162 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11163 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11164 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11165 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11168 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11169 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11170 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11171 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11172 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11173 from the child's routing.
11175 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11176 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11177 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11180 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11181 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11182 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11184 .vitem &$address_file$&
11185 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11186 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11187 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11188 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11189 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11191 /home/r2d2/savemail
11193 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11194 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11195 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11196 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11197 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11198 to the relevant file.
11200 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11201 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11202 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11203 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11205 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11206 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11207 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11208 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11210 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11211 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11212 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11213 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11214 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11215 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11216 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11217 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11218 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11219 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11220 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11221 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11222 command line option.
11224 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11225 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11226 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11227 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11228 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11229 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11230 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11231 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11232 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11236 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11237 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11238 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11239 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11240 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11241 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11242 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11243 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11244 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11245 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11246 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11248 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11249 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11250 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11251 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11252 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11255 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11256 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11257 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11258 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11259 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11260 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11261 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11262 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11263 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11264 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11265 an undefined mechanism.
11267 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11268 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11269 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11270 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11271 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11272 the ACL malware condition.
11274 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11275 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11276 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11277 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11278 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11279 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11281 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11282 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11283 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11284 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11285 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11286 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11287 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11289 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11290 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11291 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11292 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11293 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11295 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11296 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11297 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11298 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11299 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11301 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11302 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11303 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11304 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11305 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11306 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11307 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11309 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11310 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11311 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11312 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11313 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11314 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11315 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11317 .vitem &$compile_date$&
11318 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
11319 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
11321 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11322 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11323 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11324 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11325 compilations of the same version of the program.
11328 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11329 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11330 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11331 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11332 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11333 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11335 .vitem &$config_file$&
11336 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11337 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11340 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11341 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11342 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11343 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11344 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11346 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
11347 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11348 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11349 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11350 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11352 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11353 &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11354 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11355 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11356 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11357 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11359 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11360 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11361 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11362 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11363 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11364 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11365 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11366 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11367 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11368 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11369 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11371 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11372 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11374 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11375 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11376 When a message has been received this variable contains
11377 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11378 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11380 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11381 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11382 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11384 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11385 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11386 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11387 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11388 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11389 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11390 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11391 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11392 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11395 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11396 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11397 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11398 case for &$domain$&.
11400 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11401 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11402 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11403 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11405 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11406 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11407 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11408 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11409 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11410 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11412 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11413 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11414 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11416 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11419 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11420 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11421 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11422 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11423 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11424 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11425 the &(smtp)& transport.
11428 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11429 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11430 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11431 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11434 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11435 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11436 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11437 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11438 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11439 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11442 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11443 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11444 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11445 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11449 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11450 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11451 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11452 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11453 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11454 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11455 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11458 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11459 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11460 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11463 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11464 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11465 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11467 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11468 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11469 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11471 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11472 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11473 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11476 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11477 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11478 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11479 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11480 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11481 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11484 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11485 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11486 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11487 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11488 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11490 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11491 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11492 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11493 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11494 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11496 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11497 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11498 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11499 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11500 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11504 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11505 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11506 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11507 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11508 by a setting on the transport itself.
11510 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11511 of the environment variable HOME.
11515 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11516 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11517 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11518 to local and remote transports.
11520 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11521 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11522 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11523 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11524 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11525 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11526 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11529 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11530 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11531 client is connected.
11534 .vitem &$host_address$&
11535 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11536 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11537 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11538 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11540 .vitem &$host_data$&
11541 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11542 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11543 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11544 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11546 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11547 message = $host_data
11549 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11550 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11551 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11552 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11553 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11554 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11555 variables is set to &"1"&.
11558 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11559 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11562 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11563 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11564 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11567 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11568 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11569 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11570 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11571 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11572 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11573 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11574 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11575 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11576 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11578 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11579 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11580 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11582 .vitem &$host_port$&
11583 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11584 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11585 for an outbound connection.
11589 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11590 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11591 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11592 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11593 a unique name for the file.
11595 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11596 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11597 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11599 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11600 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11601 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11605 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11606 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11607 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11611 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11612 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11613 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11616 .vitem &$load_average$&
11617 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11618 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11619 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11620 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11622 .vitem &$local_part$&
11623 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11624 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11625 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11626 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11627 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11629 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11630 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11631 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11632 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11635 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11636 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11637 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11638 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11639 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11640 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11642 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11643 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11644 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11647 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11648 local part of the recipient address.
11650 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11651 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11652 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11654 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11657 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11658 abc\:xyz@test.example
11660 the value of &$local_part$& is
11664 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11665 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11668 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11670 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11671 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11672 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11674 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11675 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11676 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11677 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11678 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11679 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11680 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11682 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11683 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11684 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11685 variable expands to nothing.
11687 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11688 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11689 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11690 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11691 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11693 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11694 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11695 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11696 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11697 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11699 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11700 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11701 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11702 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11704 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11705 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11706 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11708 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11709 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11710 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11711 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11712 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11713 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11714 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11715 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11717 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11718 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11719 This contains the expanded value of the
11720 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11723 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11724 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11725 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11726 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11727 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11728 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11730 .vitem &$log_space$&
11731 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11732 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11733 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11734 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11735 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11736 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11739 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
11740 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
11741 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
11742 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
11743 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
11744 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
11745 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
11746 and &"yes"& if it was.
11748 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11749 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11750 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11751 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11752 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11753 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11754 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11757 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11758 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11759 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11760 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11761 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11763 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11764 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11765 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11766 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11767 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11768 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11771 .vitem &$message_age$&
11772 .cindex "message" "age of"
11773 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11774 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11775 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11778 .vitem &$message_body$&
11779 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11780 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11781 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11782 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11783 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11784 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11785 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11786 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11787 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11789 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11790 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11791 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11792 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11793 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11795 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11796 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11797 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11798 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11799 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11800 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11803 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11804 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11805 .cindex "message body" "size"
11806 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11807 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11808 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11809 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11810 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11812 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11813 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11814 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11815 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11816 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11817 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11818 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11819 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11821 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11822 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11823 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11824 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11825 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11826 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11828 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11829 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11830 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11831 contents of header lines is done.
11833 .vitem &$message_id$&
11834 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
11836 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11837 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11838 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11839 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11840 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11841 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11842 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11843 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11844 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11845 from the body is not counted.
11847 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11848 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11849 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11850 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11851 header and the body).
11853 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11855 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11857 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11859 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11860 message has not yet been received.
11862 .vitem &$message_size$&
11863 .cindex "size" "of message"
11864 .cindex "message" "size"
11865 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11866 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11867 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11868 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11869 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11870 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11871 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11872 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11873 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11875 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11876 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11877 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11878 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11880 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11881 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11882 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11883 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11885 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11886 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11887 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11889 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11890 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11891 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11892 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11893 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11894 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11895 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11896 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11897 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11898 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11900 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11901 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11902 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11904 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11905 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11906 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11907 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11908 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11909 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11910 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11911 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11912 the original address.
11914 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11915 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11916 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11917 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11918 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11920 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11921 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11922 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11924 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11925 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11926 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11927 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11928 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11929 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11930 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11931 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11932 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11934 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11935 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11936 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11937 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11938 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11939 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11940 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11941 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11944 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11945 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11946 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11947 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11949 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11950 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11951 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11952 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11955 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11957 This variable contains the current process id.
11959 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11960 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11961 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11962 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11963 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11964 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11965 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11966 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11967 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11968 variable"& error if encountered.
11970 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11971 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11972 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11973 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11974 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11975 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11976 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11979 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11980 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11981 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11982 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11984 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11985 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11986 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11987 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11989 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11990 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11991 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11992 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11994 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11995 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11996 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11998 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11999 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12000 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12001 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12003 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12004 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12005 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12006 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12007 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12009 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12010 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12011 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12012 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12013 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12014 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12016 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12017 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12018 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12019 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12020 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12022 .vitem &$received_count$&
12023 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12024 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12025 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12026 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12029 .vitem &$received_for$&
12030 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12031 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12032 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12033 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12034 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12036 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12037 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12038 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12039 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12040 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12041 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12042 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12045 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12046 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12047 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12048 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12049 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12051 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12053 .vitem &$received_port$&
12054 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12055 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12057 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12058 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12059 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12060 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12061 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12062 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12063 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12064 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12065 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12067 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12068 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12069 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12070 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12071 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12072 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12074 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12075 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12076 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12078 .vitem &$received_time$&
12079 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12080 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12081 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12083 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12084 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12085 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12086 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12087 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12089 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12090 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12092 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12093 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12094 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12095 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12097 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12098 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12099 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12100 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12103 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12104 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12107 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12110 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12111 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12115 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12118 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12121 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12122 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12124 .vitem &$recipients$&
12125 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12126 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12127 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12128 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12129 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12133 In a system filter file.
12135 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12136 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12137 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12138 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12140 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12144 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12145 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12146 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12147 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12148 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12149 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12152 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12153 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12154 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12155 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12158 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12159 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12160 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12161 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12162 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12163 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12164 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12166 .vitem &$return_path$&
12167 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12168 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12169 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12170 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12171 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12172 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12173 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12174 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12175 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12176 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12179 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12180 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12181 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12183 .vitem &$router_name$&
12184 .cindex "router" "name"
12185 .cindex "name" "of router"
12186 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12187 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12190 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12191 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12192 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12193 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12194 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12195 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12196 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12199 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12200 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12201 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12202 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12203 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12204 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12205 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12206 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12208 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12209 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12210 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12211 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12212 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12213 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12215 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12216 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12217 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12218 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12219 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12220 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12221 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12222 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12224 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12225 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12226 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12228 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12229 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12230 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12232 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12233 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12234 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12235 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12236 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12239 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12240 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12242 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12243 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12244 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12245 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12247 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12248 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12249 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12250 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12251 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12252 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12253 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12254 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12255 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12256 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12257 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12258 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12259 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12262 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12263 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12264 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12265 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12266 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticatied data.
12269 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12270 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12271 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12272 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12273 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12274 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12276 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12277 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12278 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12279 this variable contains that
12280 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12282 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12283 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12284 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12285 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12286 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12287 &$authenticated_id$&.
12289 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12290 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12291 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12292 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12293 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12294 resolver library states that both
12295 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12296 other times, this variable is false.
12298 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12299 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12300 library, by setting:
12305 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12306 validating resolver (eg, unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12308 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12309 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12312 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12313 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12314 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12315 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12316 other means, this variable is empty.
12318 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12319 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12320 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12321 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12322 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12323 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12324 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12326 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12327 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12328 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12329 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12331 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12332 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12333 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12336 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12337 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12338 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12339 following are true:
12342 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12344 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12345 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12346 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12348 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12349 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12350 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12352 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12353 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12354 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12356 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12357 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12358 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12359 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12361 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12363 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12364 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12368 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12369 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12370 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12371 number that was used on the remote host.
12373 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12374 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12375 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12376 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12377 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12380 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12381 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12382 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12383 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12385 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12386 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12387 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12388 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12389 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12390 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12391 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12392 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12393 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12394 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12395 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12398 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12399 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12400 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12401 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12402 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12404 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12405 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12406 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12407 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12408 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12410 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12411 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12412 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12413 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12414 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12415 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12416 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12418 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12419 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12420 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12421 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12422 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12424 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12425 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12426 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12427 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12428 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12429 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12431 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12432 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12433 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12434 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12435 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12440 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12441 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12442 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12443 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12445 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12446 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12447 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12448 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12449 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12450 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12451 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12453 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12454 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12455 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12456 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12457 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12458 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12459 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12460 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12461 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12462 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12463 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12465 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12466 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12467 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12468 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12469 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12470 message is junk mail.
12472 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12473 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12474 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12475 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12478 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12479 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12480 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12482 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12483 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12484 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12485 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12486 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12487 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12489 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12490 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12491 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12492 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12493 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12494 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12495 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12496 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12498 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12500 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12503 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12504 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12505 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12506 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12507 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12508 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12510 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12511 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12512 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12513 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12514 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12515 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12516 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12517 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12519 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12520 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12523 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12524 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12525 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12526 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12527 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12528 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12530 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12531 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12532 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12533 inbound connection when the message was received.
12534 It is only useful as the argument of a
12535 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12536 or a &%def%& condition.
12538 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12539 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12540 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12541 inbound connection when the message was received.
12542 It is only useful as the argument of a
12543 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12544 or a &%def%& condition.
12545 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12546 which is not the leaf.
12548 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12549 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12550 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12551 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12552 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12553 or a &%def%& condition.
12555 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12556 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12557 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12558 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12559 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12560 or a &%def%& condition.
12561 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12562 which is not the leaf.
12564 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12565 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12566 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12567 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12569 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verfied$& variable refers to the inbound side
12570 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12573 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12574 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12575 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12576 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12577 and &"0"& otherwise.
12579 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12580 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12581 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12582 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12583 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12584 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12585 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12586 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12587 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12589 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12590 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12591 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12593 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12594 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12596 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12597 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12598 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12599 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12601 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12602 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12603 When a message is received from a remote client connection
12604 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12606 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
12607 1 No response to request
12608 2 Response not verified
12609 3 Verification failed
12610 4 Verification succeeded
12613 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12614 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12615 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12616 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12617 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12619 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12620 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12621 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12622 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12623 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12624 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12625 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12626 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12627 which is not the leaf.
12629 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12630 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12633 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12634 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12635 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12636 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12637 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12638 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12639 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12640 which is not the leaf.
12642 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12643 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12644 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12645 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12646 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12647 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12648 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12649 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12650 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12651 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12652 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12654 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12655 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12658 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12659 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12660 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12662 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12665 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12666 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12667 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12668 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12670 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12671 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12672 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12674 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12675 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12676 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12678 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12679 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12680 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12681 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12682 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12683 values for those that are behind (west).
12686 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12687 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12688 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12690 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12691 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12692 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12693 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12696 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12697 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12698 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12701 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12702 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12703 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12704 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12706 .vitem &$transport_name$&
12707 .cindex "transport" "name"
12708 .cindex "name" "of transport"
12709 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12710 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12713 .vindex "&$value$&"
12714 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12715 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12716 &*reduce*& expansion.
12718 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
12719 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
12720 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode
12721 or for cutthrough delivery,
12722 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
12725 .vitem &$version_number$&
12726 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12727 The version number of Exim.
12729 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12730 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12731 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12732 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12734 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12735 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12736 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12737 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12743 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12744 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12746 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12747 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12748 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12749 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12750 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12751 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12756 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12759 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12760 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12761 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12762 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12763 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12764 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12765 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12766 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12767 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12769 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12770 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12771 should usually be something like
12773 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12775 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12776 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12777 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12778 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12779 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12780 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12781 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12782 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12786 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12787 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12788 a startup when Exim is entered.
12790 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12791 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12794 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12795 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12798 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12799 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12800 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12801 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12805 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12806 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12808 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12809 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12810 with an error message of the form
12812 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12814 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12815 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12816 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12817 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12818 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12819 that was passed to &%die%&.
12822 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12823 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12824 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12827 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12829 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12830 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12831 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12833 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12834 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12835 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12836 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12838 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12839 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12840 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12841 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12842 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12843 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12844 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12847 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12848 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12849 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12850 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12851 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12852 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12853 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12854 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12855 avoided, but the output is lost.
12857 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12858 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12859 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12860 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12861 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12862 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12863 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12865 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12867 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12868 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12869 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12870 as the first subroutine argument.
12874 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12875 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12877 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12878 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12879 "Starting the daemon"
12880 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12881 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12882 .cindex "network interface"
12883 .cindex "interface" "network"
12884 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12885 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12886 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12887 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12888 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12889 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12890 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12891 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12892 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12893 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12894 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12897 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12898 and ports to listen on.
12900 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12901 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12902 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12903 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12904 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12905 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12906 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12907 as an error situation.
12909 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12910 for the outgoing connection.
12914 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12915 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12916 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12917 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12918 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12920 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12921 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12922 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12923 chapter describes how they operate.
12925 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12926 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12930 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12931 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12932 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12936 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
12938 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12940 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12941 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12944 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12945 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12946 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12947 colons. For example:
12949 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12952 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12954 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12955 in &%local_interfaces%&:
12958 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12959 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12961 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12962 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12965 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12966 with a colon separator, for example:
12968 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12969 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12973 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12974 default setting contains just one port:
12976 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12978 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12979 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12980 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12981 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12982 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12986 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12987 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12988 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12989 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12990 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12991 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12993 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12995 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12997 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12999 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13003 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13004 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13005 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13006 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13007 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13008 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13011 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13012 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13013 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13014 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13015 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13016 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13020 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13023 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13025 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13026 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13027 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13031 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13032 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13033 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13034 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13035 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13036 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
13037 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
13038 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
13039 list of port numbers or service names,
13040 connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
13041 common use of this option is expected to be
13043 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13045 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
13046 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
13047 this way when a daemon is started.
13049 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13050 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13051 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13052 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13053 connections via the daemon.)
13058 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13059 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13060 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13061 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13062 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13063 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13064 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13065 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13067 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13069 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13070 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13071 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13072 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13073 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13074 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13076 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13078 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13079 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13080 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13081 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13082 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13084 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13085 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13086 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13087 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13088 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13089 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13090 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13091 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13092 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13093 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13094 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13095 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13097 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13098 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13099 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13100 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13101 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13105 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13106 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13108 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13109 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13111 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13112 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13113 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13114 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13116 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13118 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13120 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13122 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13123 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13125 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13126 IPv4 loopback address only:
13128 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13130 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13132 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13134 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13138 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13139 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13140 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13141 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13144 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13145 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13146 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13147 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13149 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13150 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13151 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13152 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13153 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13154 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13155 used for listening. Consider this example:
13157 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13159 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13161 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13163 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13164 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13167 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13168 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13169 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13170 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13171 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13172 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13173 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13174 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13178 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13179 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13180 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13181 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13182 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13183 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13189 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13190 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13192 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13193 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13194 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13195 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13198 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13199 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13201 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13202 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13203 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13205 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13206 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13207 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13208 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13212 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13213 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13214 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13215 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13216 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13217 listed in more than one group.
13219 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13221 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13222 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13223 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13224 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13225 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13226 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13227 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13228 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13229 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13233 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13235 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13236 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13237 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13238 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13239 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13240 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13245 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13247 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13248 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13249 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13250 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13251 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13252 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13253 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13254 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13255 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13256 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13257 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13262 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13264 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13265 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13266 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13267 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13268 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13269 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13270 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13271 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13272 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13273 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13274 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13275 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13276 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13281 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13283 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13284 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13285 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13286 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13291 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13293 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13294 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13295 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13296 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13297 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13298 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13299 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13300 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13301 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13302 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13303 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13304 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13305 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13306 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13307 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13312 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13314 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13315 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13320 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13322 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13323 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13328 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13330 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13331 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13332 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13333 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13334 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13335 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13336 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13341 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13343 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13344 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13345 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13346 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13347 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13348 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13349 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13350 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13351 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13352 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13353 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13354 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13355 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13356 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13357 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13358 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13360 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13361 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13362 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13363 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13364 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13369 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13371 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13372 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13373 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13374 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13375 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13376 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13377 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13378 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13379 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13380 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13381 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13382 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13383 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13384 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13385 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13386 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13387 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13388 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13389 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13390 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13391 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13392 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13394 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13395 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13396 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13397 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13398 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13399 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13400 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13401 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13402 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13403 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13404 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13405 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13406 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13407 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13408 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13409 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13410 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13411 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13416 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13418 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13420 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13422 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13423 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13424 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13429 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13431 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13432 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13433 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13434 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13435 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13436 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13437 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13438 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13439 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13440 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13441 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13442 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13443 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13444 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13445 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13446 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13447 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13452 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13454 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13455 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13456 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13457 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13458 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13459 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13460 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13461 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13466 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13468 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13469 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13470 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13471 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13472 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13473 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13474 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13475 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13481 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13483 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13490 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13491 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13494 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13495 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13496 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13497 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13498 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13499 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13500 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13501 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13502 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13503 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13504 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13505 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13506 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13507 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13508 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13510 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13511 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13512 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13513 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13514 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13515 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13516 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13517 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13518 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13519 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13520 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13521 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13522 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13523 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13524 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13525 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13530 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13532 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13533 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13534 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13535 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13536 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13537 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13538 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13539 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13544 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13546 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13547 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13548 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13549 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13551 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13552 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13553 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13554 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13555 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13556 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13557 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13558 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13559 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13560 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13565 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13567 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13568 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13570 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13571 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13572 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13573 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13574 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13579 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13581 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13582 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13583 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13584 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13585 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13586 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13587 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13588 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13589 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13590 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13591 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13592 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13593 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13594 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13595 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13596 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13597 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13598 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13599 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13600 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13601 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13602 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13603 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13608 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13610 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13611 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13612 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13613 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13614 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13615 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13616 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13617 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13618 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13619 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13620 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13621 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13622 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13623 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13628 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13629 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13632 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13634 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13635 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13636 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13637 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13638 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13639 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13640 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13642 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13643 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13644 It now defaults to true.
13645 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13647 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13650 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13652 log_selector = +8bitmime
13655 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13656 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13657 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13658 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13659 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13662 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13663 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13664 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13667 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13668 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13669 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13670 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13671 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13673 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13674 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13675 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13676 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13677 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13679 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13680 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13681 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13682 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13684 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13685 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13686 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13687 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13688 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13691 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
13692 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
13693 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
13694 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
13695 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
13697 This option defines the ACL that,
13698 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
13699 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
13700 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
13701 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13703 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
13704 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
13705 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
13706 of a received message.
13707 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>& for further details.
13709 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13710 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13711 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13712 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13714 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13715 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13716 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13717 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13719 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13720 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13721 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13722 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13723 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13726 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13727 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13728 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13729 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13731 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13732 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13733 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13734 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13735 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13737 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13738 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13739 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13740 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13741 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13743 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
13744 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
13745 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
13746 ends without a QUIT command being received.
13747 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13749 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13750 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13751 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13754 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13755 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13756 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13757 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13759 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13760 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13761 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13762 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13764 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13765 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13766 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13767 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13769 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13770 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13771 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13772 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13774 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13775 .cindex "admin user"
13776 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13777 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13778 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13779 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13780 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13781 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13782 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13784 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13785 .cindex "domain literal"
13786 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13787 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13788 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13789 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13791 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13792 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13793 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13794 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13795 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13796 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13797 the local host's IP addresses.
13800 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13801 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13802 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13803 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13804 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13805 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
13806 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13807 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13808 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13810 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13811 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13812 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13813 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13814 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13815 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13816 experiment if they wish.
13818 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13819 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13820 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13821 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13822 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13823 suitable setting is:
13825 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13826 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13828 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13830 dns_check_names_pattern =
13832 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13835 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13836 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13837 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13838 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13839 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13840 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13841 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13842 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13843 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13844 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13845 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13847 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13848 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13849 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13850 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13851 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13852 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13854 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13855 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13856 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13857 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13859 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13861 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13862 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13863 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13864 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13867 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13868 .cindex "thawing messages"
13869 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13870 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13871 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13872 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13873 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13874 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13876 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13877 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13878 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13881 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13882 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13883 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13885 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13887 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13888 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13891 .option bi_command main string unset
13893 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13894 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13895 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13896 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13899 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13900 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13901 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13902 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13903 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13904 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13907 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13908 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13909 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13910 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13912 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13913 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13914 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13915 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13916 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13917 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13918 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13919 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13920 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13921 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13923 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13924 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13925 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13926 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13929 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13930 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13931 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13932 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13933 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13934 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13935 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13936 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13937 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13939 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13940 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13941 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13942 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13943 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13946 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13947 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13948 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13949 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13950 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13951 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13952 connection. A typical setting might be:
13954 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13956 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13958 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13960 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13963 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13964 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13965 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13966 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13967 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13968 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13971 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13972 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13973 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13974 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13977 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13978 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13979 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13980 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13983 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13984 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13985 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13986 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13989 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13990 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13991 callout verification. The default value is
13993 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
13995 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13998 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13999 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14002 .option check_log_space main integer 0
14003 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14005 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14006 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14007 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14008 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14009 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14010 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14011 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14012 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14013 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14014 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14017 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
14018 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14021 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
14022 .cindex "checking disk space"
14023 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14024 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14025 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14026 message is accepted.
14028 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14029 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14030 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14031 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14032 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14033 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14034 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14035 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14038 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14039 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14041 check_spool_space = 10M
14042 check_spool_inodes = 100
14044 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14045 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14048 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14049 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14050 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14052 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14053 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14054 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14055 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14056 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14057 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14059 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14060 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14062 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14063 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14064 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14066 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14067 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14068 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14069 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14070 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14071 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14073 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14074 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14075 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14076 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14077 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14078 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14079 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14081 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14082 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14084 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14085 .cindex "warning of delay"
14086 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14087 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14088 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14089 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14090 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14091 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14092 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14095 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14097 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14098 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14099 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14100 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14104 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14105 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14107 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14109 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14110 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14111 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14113 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14114 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14115 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14116 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14117 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14118 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14119 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14120 not sent. The default is:
14122 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14123 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14124 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14125 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14128 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14129 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14130 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14131 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14133 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14134 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14135 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14136 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14137 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14138 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14139 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14140 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14142 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14143 .cindex "load average"
14144 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14145 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14146 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14147 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14148 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14151 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14152 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14153 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14154 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14155 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14156 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14157 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14158 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14160 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14161 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14162 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14163 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14164 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14165 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14166 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14167 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14169 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14170 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14171 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14172 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14175 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14176 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14177 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14178 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14179 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14180 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14181 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14184 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14185 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14186 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14187 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14188 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14189 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
14192 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14193 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14194 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14195 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14196 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14197 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14198 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14199 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14200 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14201 by a setting such as this:
14203 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14205 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14206 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14207 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14208 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14209 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14210 options are applied after this global option.
14212 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14213 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14214 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14215 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14216 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14217 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14218 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14219 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14220 value of this option. The default pattern is
14222 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14223 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14225 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14226 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14227 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14228 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14229 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14232 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14233 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14234 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14236 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14237 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14238 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14239 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14242 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14243 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14244 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14245 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14246 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14247 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14249 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14252 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14253 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14254 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14255 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14256 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14257 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14258 domain matches this list.
14260 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14261 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14262 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14265 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14266 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14267 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14268 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14269 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14270 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14271 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14272 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14273 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14274 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14275 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14276 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14278 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14281 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14282 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14285 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14286 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14287 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14288 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14289 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14290 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14293 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14296 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14297 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14298 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14299 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14302 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14303 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14304 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14305 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14306 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14307 and accepted from, these hosts.
14308 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14309 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14310 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14311 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14315 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14316 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14317 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14318 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14319 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14320 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14322 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14324 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14325 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14327 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14328 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14329 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14330 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14331 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14332 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14333 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14334 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14335 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14338 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14339 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14340 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14341 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14342 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14343 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14344 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14345 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14346 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14348 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14349 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14350 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14351 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14352 are examined. For example:
14354 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14355 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14356 postmaster@mydomain.example
14358 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14359 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14360 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14361 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14362 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14363 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14364 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14367 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14368 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14369 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14371 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14373 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14374 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14375 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14376 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14377 overrides the default.
14379 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14380 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14381 and warning messages. For example:
14383 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14385 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14386 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14387 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14388 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14392 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14393 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14394 .cindex "Exim group"
14395 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14396 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14397 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14398 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14399 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14403 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14404 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14405 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14406 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14407 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14408 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14410 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14411 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14412 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14413 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14416 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14417 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14418 .cindex "Exim user"
14419 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14420 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14421 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14422 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14424 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14425 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14426 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14427 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14430 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14431 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14432 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14433 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14436 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14437 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14439 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
14440 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14442 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14443 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14444 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14445 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14446 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14447 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14448 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14449 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14450 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14451 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14455 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14456 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14457 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14458 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14459 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14460 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14461 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14462 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14465 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14466 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14467 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14468 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14472 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14473 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14474 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14475 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14476 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14477 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14478 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14479 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14480 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14481 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14482 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14483 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14484 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14485 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14486 logging that you require.
14489 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14491 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14492 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14493 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14494 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14495 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14496 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14497 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14498 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14500 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14501 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14502 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14505 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14506 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14507 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14508 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14510 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14514 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14515 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14518 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14519 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14520 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14521 implementations of TLS.
14524 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14525 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14526 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14529 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14534 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14535 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14536 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14537 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14538 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14539 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14543 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14544 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14545 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14546 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14547 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14548 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14549 sections are rejected.
14552 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14553 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14554 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14555 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14556 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14557 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14558 zero means &"no limit"&.
14563 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14564 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14565 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14566 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14567 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14568 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14569 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14570 if you want to do semantic checking.
14571 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14575 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14576 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14577 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14578 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14579 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14580 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14581 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14583 helo_allow_chars = _
14585 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14588 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14589 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14590 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14591 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14592 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14593 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14594 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14598 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14599 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14600 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14601 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14602 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14603 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14604 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14605 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14606 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14607 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14608 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14609 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14611 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14612 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14613 EHLO command either:
14616 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14618 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14619 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14620 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14621 calling host address, or
14623 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
14626 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14627 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14628 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14630 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
14631 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14632 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
14634 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14635 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14636 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14637 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14638 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14639 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14640 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14641 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14642 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14645 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14646 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14647 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14648 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14649 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14650 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14651 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14652 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14653 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14655 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14656 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14657 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14658 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14659 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14661 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14662 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14663 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14664 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14667 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14668 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14669 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14670 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14671 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14672 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14673 default configuration file contains
14677 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14678 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14680 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14681 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14682 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14684 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14685 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14686 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14687 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14688 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14689 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14692 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14693 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14694 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14695 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14696 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14699 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14700 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14701 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14702 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14706 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14707 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14708 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14709 as soon as the connection is made.
14710 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14711 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14712 connections immediately.
14714 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14715 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14716 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14717 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14718 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14721 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14722 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14723 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14724 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14725 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14726 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14727 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14728 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14729 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14731 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14733 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14737 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14738 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14739 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14740 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14741 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14743 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14744 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14746 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14747 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14748 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14749 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14750 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14751 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14752 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14755 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14756 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14757 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14758 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14759 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14763 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14764 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14765 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14766 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14767 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14768 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14770 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14771 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14772 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14773 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14774 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14775 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14776 for frozen messages. For example,
14778 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14780 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14781 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14782 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14783 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14784 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14785 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14788 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14789 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14790 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14791 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14792 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14793 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14794 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14795 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14796 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14797 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14800 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14801 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14804 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14805 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14806 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14807 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14811 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14812 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14813 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14814 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14815 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14816 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14817 and constrained to be a directory.
14820 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14821 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14822 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14823 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14824 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14825 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14826 and constrained to be a file.
14829 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14830 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14831 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14832 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14833 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14836 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14837 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14838 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14839 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14840 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14841 identity to be proven.
14844 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14845 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14846 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14847 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14848 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14851 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14852 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14853 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14854 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14855 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14859 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14860 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14861 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14862 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14863 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14864 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14868 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14869 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14870 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14871 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14872 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14874 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14875 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14878 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14879 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14880 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14881 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14882 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14883 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14884 has been built with LDAP support.
14888 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14889 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14890 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14891 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14892 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14893 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14894 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14896 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14897 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14898 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14900 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14901 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14902 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14903 and the default qualify domain.
14905 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14906 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14907 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14908 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14910 .cindex "envelope sender"
14911 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14912 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14913 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14915 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14916 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14917 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14922 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14923 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14924 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14925 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14926 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14927 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14928 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14931 local_from_prefix = *-
14933 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14935 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14937 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14938 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14942 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
14943 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14946 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14947 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14948 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14949 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14950 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14951 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14952 &%local_interfaces%& is
14954 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14956 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
14958 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14961 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
14962 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
14963 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
14964 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
14965 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
14966 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
14967 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
14968 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
14972 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
14973 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
14974 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14975 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
14976 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
14977 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
14978 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
14979 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14984 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
14985 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
14986 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
14987 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
14988 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
14989 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
14990 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
14991 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
14992 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
14993 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
14994 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
14995 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
14996 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
14997 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
14998 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15002 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15003 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15004 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15005 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15006 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15007 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15008 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15009 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15010 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15011 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15012 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15013 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15014 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15015 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15016 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15019 .option log_selector main string unset
15020 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15021 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15022 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15023 minus characters. For example:
15025 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15027 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15028 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15031 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15032 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15033 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15034 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15035 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15036 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15037 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15038 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15039 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15040 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15041 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15042 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15043 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15046 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15047 .cindex "too many open files"
15048 .cindex "open files, too many"
15049 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15050 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15051 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15052 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15053 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15054 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15055 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15056 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15057 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15058 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15059 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15060 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15063 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15064 .cindex "length of login name"
15065 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15066 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15067 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15068 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15069 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15070 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15073 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15074 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15075 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15076 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15077 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15078 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15079 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15080 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15083 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15084 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15085 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15086 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15087 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15088 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15089 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15092 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15093 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15094 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15095 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15096 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15097 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15098 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15099 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15100 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15101 empty string, the option is ignored.
15104 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15105 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15106 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15107 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15108 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15109 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15110 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15111 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15112 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15113 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15114 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15115 colons will become hyphens.
15118 .option message_logs main boolean true
15119 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15120 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15121 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15122 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15123 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15124 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15125 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15126 which is not affected by this option.
15129 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15130 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15131 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15132 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15133 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15134 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15135 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15136 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15137 optionally followed by K or M.
15139 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15140 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15141 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15142 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15143 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15145 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15146 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15147 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15148 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15149 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15150 message that an individual transport can process.
15152 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15153 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15154 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15155 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15156 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
15157 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15158 some problems may result.
15160 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15161 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15162 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15165 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15166 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15167 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15169 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15171 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15172 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15173 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15174 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15175 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15178 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15179 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15180 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15181 contains a full description of this facility.
15185 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15186 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15187 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15188 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15189 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15192 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15193 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15194 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15195 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15196 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15199 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15200 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15201 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15202 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15203 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15205 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15206 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15209 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15211 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15212 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15216 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
15217 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15218 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15219 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15220 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15222 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15223 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15224 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15225 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15226 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15227 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15228 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15230 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15231 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15232 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15233 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15234 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15236 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15238 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15239 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15240 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15241 some now infamous attacks.
15245 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15246 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15247 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15249 # Disable older protocol versions:
15250 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15253 Possible options may include:
15257 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15259 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15261 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15265 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15267 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15269 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15271 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15273 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15275 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15279 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15293 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15297 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15299 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15301 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15303 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15307 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15310 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15311 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15312 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15313 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15314 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15315 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15318 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15319 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15320 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15321 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15322 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15325 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15326 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15327 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15328 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15329 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15330 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15331 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15332 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15333 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15334 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15337 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15338 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15339 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15340 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15341 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15342 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15343 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15346 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15347 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15348 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15351 .option perl_startup main string unset
15352 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15353 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15356 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15357 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15358 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15359 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15360 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15361 PostgreSQL support.
15364 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15365 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15366 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15367 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15368 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15371 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15373 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15375 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15376 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15377 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15380 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15381 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15382 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15383 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15384 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15385 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15386 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15387 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15388 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15391 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15392 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15393 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15394 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15395 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15396 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15397 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15398 is recieved. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15400 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15401 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15402 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15403 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15404 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15405 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15406 volume of mail. Use with care!
15409 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15410 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15411 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15412 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15413 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15414 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15415 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15416 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15417 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15418 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15420 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15421 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15422 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15423 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15424 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15425 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15428 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15429 .cindex "printing characters"
15430 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15431 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
15432 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15433 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15434 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15435 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15438 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15439 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15440 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15441 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15442 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15446 .option process_log_path main string unset
15447 .cindex "process log path"
15448 .cindex "log" "process log"
15449 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15450 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15451 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15452 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15453 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15454 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15455 different spool directories.
15458 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15462 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15463 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15464 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15467 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15468 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15469 .cindex "address" "qualification"
15470 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15471 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15472 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15473 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15474 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15475 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15477 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15478 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15479 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15480 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15481 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15482 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15483 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15486 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15487 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15488 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15492 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15493 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15494 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15495 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15496 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15497 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15498 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15499 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15502 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15504 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15505 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15506 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15509 .option queue_only main boolean false
15510 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15511 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15512 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15513 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15514 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15515 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15517 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15518 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15519 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15520 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15523 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15524 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15525 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15526 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15527 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15528 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15529 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15530 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15531 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15533 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15535 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15536 &_/some/file_& exists.
15539 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15540 .cindex "load average"
15541 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15542 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15543 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15544 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15545 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15546 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15547 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15550 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15551 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15552 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15553 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15556 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15557 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15558 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15559 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15560 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15561 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15562 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15563 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15564 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15565 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15566 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15567 re-evaluated for each message.
15570 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
15571 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15572 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15573 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15574 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15575 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15578 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15579 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15580 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15581 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15582 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15583 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15584 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15585 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15586 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15587 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15588 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15589 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15590 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15594 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
15595 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15596 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15597 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15598 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15599 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15600 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15601 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15602 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15604 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15605 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15606 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15607 the daemon's command line.
15609 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15610 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15611 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15612 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15613 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15614 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15615 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15616 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15617 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15618 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15619 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15620 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15621 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15625 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15626 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15627 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15628 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15629 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15630 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15631 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15633 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15634 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15635 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15636 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15637 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15638 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15639 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15640 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15641 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15642 header lines. The default setting is:
15645 received_header_text = Received: \
15646 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15647 {${if def:sender_ident \
15648 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15649 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15650 by $primary_hostname \
15651 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15652 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15653 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15654 ${if def:sender_address \
15655 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15656 id $message_exim_id\
15657 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15660 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15661 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15662 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15663 header lines such as the following:
15665 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15666 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15667 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15668 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15669 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15670 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15671 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15673 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15674 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15675 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15676 message was accepted.
15679 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15680 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15681 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15682 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15683 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15684 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15685 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15686 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15689 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15690 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15691 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15692 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15693 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15694 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15695 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15696 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15697 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15698 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15699 option was not set.
15702 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15703 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15704 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15705 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15706 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15707 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15708 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15709 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15712 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15713 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15714 RCPT commands in a single message.
15717 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15718 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15719 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15720 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15721 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15722 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15723 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15726 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15727 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15728 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15729 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15730 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15731 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15732 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15733 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15734 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15735 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15736 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15737 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15738 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15739 tagged with its process id.
15741 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15742 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15743 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15744 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15747 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15748 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15749 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15750 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15751 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15752 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15753 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15754 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15755 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15756 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15757 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15759 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15760 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15761 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15762 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15765 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15766 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15767 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15768 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15769 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15771 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15773 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15774 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15777 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15778 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15779 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15780 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15781 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15785 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15786 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15787 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15788 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15789 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15790 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15791 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15795 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15796 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15797 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15798 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15799 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15800 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15801 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15802 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15803 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15804 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15807 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15808 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15812 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
15814 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15815 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
15816 an item in the list.
15817 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
15822 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
15824 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15825 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15826 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15827 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15830 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15831 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15832 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15833 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15834 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15835 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15836 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15837 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15838 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15839 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15842 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
15843 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
15844 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
15845 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
15846 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
15847 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
15848 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
15852 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15853 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15854 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15855 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15856 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15857 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15858 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15859 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15860 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15861 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15862 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15866 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15867 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15868 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15870 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15871 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15872 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15873 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15874 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15875 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15877 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15878 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15879 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15880 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15883 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15884 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15885 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15886 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15887 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15888 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15889 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15890 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15892 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15893 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15894 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15895 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15896 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15897 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15898 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15899 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15902 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15903 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15904 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15905 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15909 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15910 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15911 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
15912 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
15913 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
15914 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
15915 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
15916 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
15917 . the option name to split.
15919 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15920 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15921 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15922 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15923 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15924 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15925 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15926 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15927 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15931 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15932 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15933 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15934 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15935 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
15936 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
15937 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
15938 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
15939 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
15940 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
15941 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
15943 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
15944 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
15945 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
15946 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
15947 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
15948 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
15952 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
15953 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15954 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15955 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
15956 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
15957 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
15958 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
15959 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
15960 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
15961 to all messages received in the same connection.
15963 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
15964 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
15965 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
15966 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
15969 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15971 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
15972 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
15973 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15974 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
15975 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
15976 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
15977 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
15978 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
15979 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
15980 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
15981 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
15982 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
15983 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
15986 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
15987 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
15988 .cindex "host" "reserved"
15989 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
15990 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
15991 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
15992 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
15993 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
15994 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
15995 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
15996 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
15999 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16000 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16001 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16002 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16005 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16006 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16007 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16008 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16009 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16010 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16011 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16012 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16013 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16015 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16016 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16017 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16018 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16020 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16021 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16022 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16023 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16024 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16027 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16028 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16031 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16032 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16033 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16034 &%helo_data%& value.
16036 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16037 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16038 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16039 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16040 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16041 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16042 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16044 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16045 $version_number $tod_full
16047 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16048 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16049 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16050 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16051 multiline response).
16054 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16055 .cindex "checking disk space"
16056 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16057 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16058 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16059 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16060 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16061 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16062 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16065 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16066 .cindex "connection backlog"
16067 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16068 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16069 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16070 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16071 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16072 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16073 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16074 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16075 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16076 attacks by SYN flooding.
16079 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16080 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16081 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16082 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16083 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16084 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16085 fewer, but they still exist.
16087 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16088 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16089 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16090 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16091 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16092 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16093 does detect many instances.
16095 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16096 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16097 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16098 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16102 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16103 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16104 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16105 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16106 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16107 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16108 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16109 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16112 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16113 $sender_host_address
16115 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16116 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16117 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16118 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16119 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16123 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16124 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16125 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16126 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16127 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16130 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16131 .cindex "load average"
16132 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16133 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16134 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16135 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16136 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16137 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16141 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16142 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16143 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16144 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16145 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16147 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16149 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16150 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16151 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16152 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16153 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16155 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16156 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16157 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16158 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16159 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16160 not count towards the limit.
16164 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16165 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16166 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16167 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16168 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16171 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16172 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16176 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16177 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16178 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16179 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16180 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16181 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16184 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16185 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16186 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16187 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16189 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16190 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16191 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16192 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16196 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16198 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16199 fractional parts are allowed here.
16201 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16203 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16204 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16207 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16208 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16210 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16211 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16213 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16214 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16215 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16216 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16219 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16220 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16223 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16224 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16227 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16228 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16229 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16230 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16231 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16232 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16233 the message is abandoned.
16234 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16236 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16237 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16239 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16240 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16242 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16243 expanded before use and may depend on
16244 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16248 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16249 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16250 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16251 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16252 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16255 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16256 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16257 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16260 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16261 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16262 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16263 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16264 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16265 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16266 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16267 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16268 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16269 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16271 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16272 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16275 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
16276 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16277 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16278 The default value is
16282 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16286 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16287 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16288 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16289 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16290 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16291 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16292 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16293 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16294 arrival of the message.
16296 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16297 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16298 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16299 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16300 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16302 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16303 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16304 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16305 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16306 automatically deleted.
16308 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16309 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16310 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16311 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16312 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16313 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16314 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16315 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16316 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16319 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16320 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16321 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16322 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16323 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16324 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16325 &$primary_hostname$&.
16327 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16328 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16329 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16330 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16331 as failures in the configuration file.
16333 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16334 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16336 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16337 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16338 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16339 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16341 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16342 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16343 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16344 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16345 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16346 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16348 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16349 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16350 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16351 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16352 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16353 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16354 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16357 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16358 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16359 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16360 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16361 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16362 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16363 domain causes a syntax error.
16364 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16368 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16369 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16370 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16371 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16372 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16373 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16374 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16375 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16376 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16377 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16378 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16379 the LOG_ALERT priority.
16382 .option syslog_facility main string unset
16383 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16384 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16385 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16386 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16387 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16388 details of Exim's logging.
16392 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16393 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16394 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16395 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16396 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16400 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16401 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16402 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16403 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16404 details of Exim's logging.
16407 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
16408 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
16409 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16410 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16411 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16412 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16413 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16414 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16415 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16416 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16417 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16420 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16421 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
16422 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16423 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16424 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16425 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16428 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16429 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16430 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16431 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16432 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16434 .option system_filter_group main string unset
16435 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16436 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16437 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16438 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16440 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16441 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16442 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16443 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16444 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16445 contains the pipe command.
16448 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16449 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16450 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16451 is used in a system filter.
16454 .option system_filter_user main string unset
16455 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16456 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16457 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16458 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16459 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16460 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16461 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16462 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16463 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16465 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16466 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16467 transport option overrides.
16470 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16471 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16472 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16473 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16474 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16475 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16476 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16477 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16478 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16479 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16480 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16481 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16485 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16486 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16487 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16488 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16489 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16490 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16491 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16492 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16493 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16494 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16496 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16497 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16498 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16501 .option timezone main string unset
16502 .cindex "timezone, setting"
16503 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16504 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16505 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16506 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16510 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16511 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16512 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16513 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16514 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16515 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16518 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16519 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16520 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16521 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16522 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16523 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16524 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16525 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16528 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16529 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16530 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16531 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16532 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16533 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16534 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16536 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16537 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16538 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16539 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16541 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16542 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16543 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16544 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16546 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16547 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16548 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16549 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16550 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16552 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16555 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16556 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16557 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16558 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16559 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16560 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16562 The value must be at least 1024.
16564 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16565 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16566 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16568 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16571 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16572 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16573 larger prime than requested.
16576 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16577 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16578 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16579 to be used by Exim.
16581 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16582 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16583 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16584 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16585 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16586 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16587 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16589 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16592 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16593 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16594 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16595 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16597 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16598 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
16599 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16600 in IKE is assigned number 23.
16602 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16603 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16604 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16607 The available primes are:
16608 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16609 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16610 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16612 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16613 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16615 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16616 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16617 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16618 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16619 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16622 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16623 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16624 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16625 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16626 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16627 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16628 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16631 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! prime256v1
16632 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
16633 If built with a recent-enough version of OpenSSL,
16634 this option selects a EC curve for use by Exim.
16636 Curve names of the form &'prime256v1'& are accepted.
16637 For even more-recent library versions, names of the form &'P-512'&
16638 are also accepted, plus the special value &'auto'&
16639 which tell the library to choose.
16641 If the option is set to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
16644 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
16645 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
16646 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
16648 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
16649 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
16650 Certificate Authority.
16653 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16656 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16657 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16658 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16659 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16663 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16664 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16665 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16666 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16667 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16668 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16669 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16671 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16674 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16675 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16676 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16677 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16678 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16679 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16683 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16684 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16685 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16686 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16687 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16688 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16689 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16690 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16691 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16692 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16693 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16696 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16697 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16698 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16699 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16703 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
16704 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16705 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16706 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
16708 or the absolute path to
16709 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
16710 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
16712 The "system" value for the option will use a
16713 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
16714 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
16715 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
16718 The use of a directory for the option value is not avilable for GnuTLS versions
16719 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
16721 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
16723 either by file or directory
16724 are added to those given by the system default location.
16727 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16728 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16729 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16730 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16731 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16732 use the explicit directory version.
16734 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16736 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16740 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16741 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16742 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16743 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16744 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16745 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16746 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16747 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16749 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16750 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16751 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16752 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16753 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16754 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16755 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16757 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16758 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16759 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16760 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16761 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16762 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16763 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16766 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16770 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16771 .cindex "trusted groups"
16772 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
16773 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16774 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16775 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16776 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16777 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16778 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16781 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16782 .cindex "trusted users"
16783 .cindex "user" "trusted"
16784 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16785 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16786 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16787 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16788 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16789 Exim user are trusted.
16791 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16792 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16793 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16794 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16795 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16796 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16797 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16798 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16799 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16802 .option unknown_username main string unset
16803 See &%unknown_login%&.
16805 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16806 .cindex "trusted users"
16807 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16808 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16809 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16810 .cindex "envelope sender"
16811 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16812 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16813 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16814 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16815 is used) is ignored.
16817 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16818 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16820 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16822 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16823 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16824 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16825 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16826 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16827 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16828 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16829 followed by a hyphen
16830 by a setting like this:
16832 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16834 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16835 restriction, you can use
16837 untrusted_set_sender = *
16839 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16840 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16841 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16842 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16843 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16844 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16845 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16846 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16848 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16849 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16850 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16851 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16855 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16856 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16857 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16858 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16859 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16860 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16861 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16862 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16863 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16864 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16866 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16867 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16869 The pattern can be seen by running
16871 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16873 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16874 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16875 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16876 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16877 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16878 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16881 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16882 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16885 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16886 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16887 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16888 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16889 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16890 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16891 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16892 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16895 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16896 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16897 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16898 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16899 .ecindex IIDconfima
16900 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16905 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16906 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16908 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16909 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16910 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16911 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16912 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
16914 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16915 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16916 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16917 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16918 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16922 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
16923 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
16924 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
16925 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
16926 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
16927 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
16928 delivery of the address to be deferred.
16930 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16931 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
16932 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
16933 routers, and the eventual transport.
16935 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
16936 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
16937 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
16938 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
16939 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
16941 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
16942 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
16943 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
16944 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
16945 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
16947 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
16948 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
16949 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
16951 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
16953 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
16955 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
16957 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
16958 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
16960 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
16961 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16962 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
16963 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
16964 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
16965 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
16966 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
16970 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
16972 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
16973 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
16974 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
16975 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
16976 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
16981 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
16982 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
16983 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
16984 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
16985 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
16986 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
16987 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
16988 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
16989 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
16990 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
16993 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
16995 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
16998 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17000 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17001 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17002 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17003 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17006 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17007 .cindex "case of local parts"
17008 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17009 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17010 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17011 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17012 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17013 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17014 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17017 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17018 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17019 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17020 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17021 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17022 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17023 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17024 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17025 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17027 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17028 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17029 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17030 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17034 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17035 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17036 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17037 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17039 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17040 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17041 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17042 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17043 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17044 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17045 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17046 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17047 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17048 the router is skipped.
17050 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17051 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17052 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17053 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17054 setting to achieve this. For example:
17056 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17058 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17059 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17060 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17064 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17065 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17066 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17067 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17068 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17069 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17070 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17071 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17073 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17074 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17076 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17077 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17079 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17080 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17081 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17083 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17085 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17087 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17090 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17092 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17093 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17097 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17098 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17099 be specified using &%condition%&.
17101 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17102 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17103 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17104 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17105 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17106 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17107 Router rules processing behavior.
17109 This is best illustrated in an example:
17111 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17112 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17114 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17117 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17120 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17121 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17122 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17123 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17124 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17125 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17126 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17127 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17129 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17130 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17131 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17132 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17135 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17136 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17137 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17138 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17139 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17142 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17143 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17144 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17145 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17146 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17147 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17148 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17149 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17150 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17151 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17152 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17153 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17154 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17155 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17159 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17160 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17161 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17162 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17163 transport option of the same name.
17165 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17166 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17167 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17168 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17169 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17170 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17171 the dnssec request bit set.
17172 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17174 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17175 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17176 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17177 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17178 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17179 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17180 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17181 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17182 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17185 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17186 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17187 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17188 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17189 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17190 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17191 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17192 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17196 .option driver routers string unset
17197 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17202 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17203 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17204 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17205 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17206 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17207 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17208 Not effective on redirect routers.
17213 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17214 .cindex "envelope sender"
17215 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17216 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17217 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17218 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17219 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17220 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17221 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17223 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17224 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17225 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17228 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17229 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17230 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17231 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17233 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17234 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17235 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17236 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17242 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17243 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17244 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17245 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17246 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17248 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17249 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17250 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17251 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17252 setting &%return_path%&.
17254 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17255 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17256 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17260 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17261 .cindex "address" "testing"
17262 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17263 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17264 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17265 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17266 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17267 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17268 on for the system alias file.
17269 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17272 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17273 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17274 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17278 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17279 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17280 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17281 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17285 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17286 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17287 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17291 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17292 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17293 verifying a sender, verification fails.
17297 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17298 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17299 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17300 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17301 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17302 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17303 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17304 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17305 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17307 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17308 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17309 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17310 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17311 transport for further details.
17314 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
17315 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17316 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17317 .cindex "transport" "local"
17318 .cindex "router" "setting group"
17319 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17320 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17322 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17323 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17324 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17325 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17326 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17330 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17331 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
17332 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17333 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17335 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17337 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17338 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17339 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17340 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17341 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17342 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17343 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17344 &"see"& the added header lines.
17346 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17347 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17348 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17349 failures are treated as configuration errors.
17351 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17352 for a router; all listed headers are added.
17354 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17355 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17357 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17358 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
17359 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17360 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17361 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17362 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17363 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17364 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17365 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17366 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17370 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17371 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
17372 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17373 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17375 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17377 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17378 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17379 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17380 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17381 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17382 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17383 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17384 &"see"& the original header lines.
17386 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17387 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17388 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17391 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17392 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17394 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17395 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17397 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17398 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17399 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17400 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17403 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17404 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17405 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17406 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17407 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17408 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17409 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17412 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17416 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17418 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17419 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17420 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17421 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17422 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17423 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17425 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17426 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17428 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17429 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17431 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17432 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17434 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17435 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17436 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17437 domain that is being routed.
17439 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17440 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17443 .option initgroups routers boolean false
17444 .cindex "additional groups"
17445 .cindex "groups" "additional"
17446 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17447 .cindex "transport" "local"
17448 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17449 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17450 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17451 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17452 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17456 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
17457 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
17458 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
17459 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
17460 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
17461 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
17464 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
17465 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
17466 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
17467 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
17468 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
17469 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
17470 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
17471 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
17472 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
17474 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17475 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
17476 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
17477 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
17478 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
17479 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
17480 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
17481 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
17482 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
17483 the relevant transport.
17485 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
17486 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
17487 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
17490 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
17491 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
17492 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
17493 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
17494 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
17498 local_part_prefix = real-
17500 transport = local_delivery
17502 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
17503 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
17505 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
17506 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
17509 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
17510 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
17511 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
17512 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
17515 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
17516 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
17520 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
17521 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
17522 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
17523 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
17524 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
17525 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
17526 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
17527 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
17528 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
17532 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
17533 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
17537 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
17538 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
17539 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
17540 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
17541 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17543 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
17544 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
17547 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
17549 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
17550 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
17551 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
17552 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
17553 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
17554 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
17555 each virtual domain:
17559 local_parts = postmaster
17560 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
17564 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
17565 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
17566 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
17567 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
17568 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
17569 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
17570 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
17571 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
17572 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
17573 redirect addresses.
17577 .option more routers boolean&!! true
17578 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17579 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17580 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17581 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
17582 delivery to be deferred.
17584 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
17585 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17587 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17588 means of the setting
17592 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17593 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17594 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17596 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17597 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17598 controls what happens next.
17601 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17602 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
17603 .cindex "router" "timeout"
17604 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17605 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17606 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17607 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17608 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17610 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17611 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17612 applies to all of them.
17616 .option pass_router routers string unset
17617 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17618 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17619 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17620 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17621 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17622 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17623 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17624 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17625 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17626 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17630 .option redirect_router routers string unset
17631 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17632 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17633 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17634 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17635 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17637 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17638 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17639 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17640 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17644 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17645 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17646 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17647 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17648 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17649 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17650 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17652 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17653 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17654 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17655 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17657 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17658 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17659 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17660 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17661 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17664 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17665 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17668 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17669 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17670 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17671 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17672 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17673 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17674 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17675 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17677 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17678 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17679 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17680 operates as follows:
17682 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17683 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17684 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17685 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17688 require_files = mail:/some/file
17689 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17691 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17692 &%require_files%& condition fails.
17694 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17695 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17696 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17697 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17699 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17700 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17701 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17702 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17703 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17705 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17706 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17707 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17708 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17709 check again in that process.
17711 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17712 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17713 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17714 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17715 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17716 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17717 as if the file did not exist. For example:
17719 require_files = +/some/file
17721 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17722 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17723 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17727 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17728 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17729 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17730 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17731 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17732 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17733 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17734 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17737 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17738 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17739 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17740 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17741 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17744 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17745 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17746 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17750 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17751 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
17752 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
17754 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17755 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17756 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17757 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17758 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17759 cause the router to defer.
17761 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17762 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17764 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17766 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17767 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17769 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17770 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17771 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17772 of these values that is set:
17775 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17777 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17779 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17781 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17784 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17785 router, but not for the transport.
17789 .option self routers string freeze
17790 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17791 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17792 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17793 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17794 and &(manualroute)& routers.
17795 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17797 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17798 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17799 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17800 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17801 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17803 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17804 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17805 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17806 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17807 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17812 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17814 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17815 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17816 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17817 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17819 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17820 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17821 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17826 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17827 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17828 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17829 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17830 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17831 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17837 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17838 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17839 be passed to the next router.
17842 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17845 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
17846 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17847 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17848 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17849 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17850 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17855 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17856 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
17857 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17858 address matches something on the list.
17859 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17862 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17863 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17864 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17865 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17866 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17867 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17868 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17872 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17873 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
17874 .cindex "packet radio"
17875 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17876 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17877 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17878 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17879 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17880 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17881 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17882 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17884 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17885 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17886 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17887 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17888 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17889 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17890 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17891 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17892 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17893 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17895 translate_ip_address = \
17896 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17899 The file would contain lines like
17901 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
17902 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17904 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17909 .option transport routers string&!! unset
17910 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17911 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17912 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17913 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17914 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17915 delivery is deferred.
17917 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
17918 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
17919 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
17923 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
17924 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
17925 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
17926 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
17927 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
17928 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
17929 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
17930 overridden by a setting on the transport.
17931 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17932 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17933 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
17939 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
17940 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
17941 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
17942 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
17943 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
17944 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
17945 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
17946 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
17947 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17948 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17950 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
17951 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
17952 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
17953 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
17954 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
17956 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
17962 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
17963 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
17964 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17965 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17966 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17967 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
17968 delivery to be deferred.
17970 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
17971 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
17972 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
17973 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
17974 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
17975 sometimes true and sometimes false).
17977 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
17978 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
17979 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
17980 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
17981 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
17982 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
17983 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
17984 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
17986 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
17987 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
17988 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
17989 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
17990 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
17991 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
17992 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
17993 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
17994 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
17995 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17997 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
17998 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
17999 subsequent routers.
18002 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18003 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18004 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18005 .cindex "transport" "local"
18006 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18007 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18008 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18009 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18010 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18011 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18012 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18013 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18014 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18015 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18016 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18017 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18021 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18022 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18023 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18026 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18027 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18029 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18030 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18031 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18032 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18033 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18034 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18035 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18037 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18038 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18039 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18043 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18044 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18046 delivering in cutthrough mode
18047 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18048 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18050 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18053 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18054 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18055 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18056 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18058 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18059 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18060 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18067 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18068 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18070 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18071 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18072 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18073 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18074 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18075 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18076 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18077 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18078 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18082 domains = mydomain.example
18084 transport = local_delivery
18086 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18087 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18088 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18089 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18096 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18097 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18099 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18100 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18101 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18102 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18103 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18104 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18106 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18107 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18108 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18109 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18112 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18113 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18114 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18115 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18116 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18117 generic option, the router declines.
18119 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18120 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18121 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18123 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18124 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18125 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18126 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18127 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18128 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18131 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18132 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18133 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18134 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18135 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18136 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18138 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18139 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18140 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18141 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18142 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18143 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18144 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18145 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18146 case routing fails.
18149 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18150 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18151 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18152 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18153 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18155 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18156 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18158 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18160 The domain does not exist in DNS
18162 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18163 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18164 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18166 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18168 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18170 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18171 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18173 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18174 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18176 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18177 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18179 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18180 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18186 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18187 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18188 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18190 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18191 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18192 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18193 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18194 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18195 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18196 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18199 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18200 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18201 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18202 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18203 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18204 required. For example,
18208 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18209 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18210 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18211 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18212 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18215 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18216 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18217 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18218 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18219 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18220 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18222 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18223 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18224 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18225 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18226 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18227 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18228 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18229 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18231 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18232 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18237 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18238 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18239 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18240 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18241 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18242 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18243 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18244 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18248 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18249 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18250 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18251 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18252 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18253 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18254 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18257 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18259 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18260 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18261 the address record.
18264 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18265 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18266 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18267 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18272 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18273 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18274 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18275 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18276 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18277 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18278 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18279 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18280 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18285 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18286 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18287 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18288 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18289 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18290 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18291 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18292 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18293 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18294 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18295 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18297 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18298 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18301 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18302 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18303 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18304 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18305 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18309 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18310 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18311 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18312 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18313 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18314 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18315 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18316 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18318 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18319 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18320 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18321 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18322 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18323 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18324 without processing them independently,
18325 provided the following conditions are met:
18328 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18329 &%headers_remove%&.
18331 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18338 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18339 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18340 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18341 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18342 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18343 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18344 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18345 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18346 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18347 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18349 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18350 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18355 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18356 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18357 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18358 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18363 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18364 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18365 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18366 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18369 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18371 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18372 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18373 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18374 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18375 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18376 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18379 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18380 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18381 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18382 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18383 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18385 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18386 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18387 such as that implied by
18391 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18392 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18393 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18394 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18404 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18405 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18407 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18408 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18409 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18410 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18411 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18412 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18413 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18414 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18415 router handles the address
18419 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18420 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18421 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18423 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18425 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18426 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18428 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18429 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18430 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18431 &%self%& option determines what happens.
18433 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18434 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18435 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18436 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18440 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18441 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18443 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18444 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18445 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18446 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18447 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18448 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18451 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18453 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
18455 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
18456 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
18457 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
18458 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
18459 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
18460 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
18461 must not be specified for it.
18463 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
18464 .option hosts iplookup string unset
18465 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
18466 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
18467 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
18468 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
18469 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
18472 .option optional iplookup boolean false
18473 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
18474 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
18475 delivery to the address is deferred.
18478 .option port iplookup integer 0
18479 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
18480 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
18484 .option protocol iplookup string udp
18485 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
18486 protocols is to be used.
18489 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
18490 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
18493 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
18495 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
18496 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
18499 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
18500 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
18501 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
18502 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
18503 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
18504 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
18505 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
18506 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
18509 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
18510 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
18511 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
18512 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
18513 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
18514 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
18515 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
18516 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
18517 following could be used:
18519 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
18520 reroute = $local_part@$1
18523 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
18524 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
18525 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
18526 call. It does not apply to UDP.
18531 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18532 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18534 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
18535 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
18536 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
18537 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
18538 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
18539 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
18540 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
18541 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
18542 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
18543 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
18545 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
18546 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
18547 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
18548 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
18549 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
18550 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
18551 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
18554 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
18555 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
18556 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
18557 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
18558 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
18559 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
18560 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
18563 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
18564 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
18565 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
18566 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
18567 below, following the list of private options.
18570 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
18572 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
18573 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
18575 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
18576 See &%host_find_failed%&.
18578 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
18579 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
18580 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
18581 of the following values:
18590 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
18591 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
18592 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
18595 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
18596 router only if &%more%& is true.
18598 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
18599 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18600 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18601 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18603 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18604 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18605 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18608 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18609 .cindex "randomized host list"
18610 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18611 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18612 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18613 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18614 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18615 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18616 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18617 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18619 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18620 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18621 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18622 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18624 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18626 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18627 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18628 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18629 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18630 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18633 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18634 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18635 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18638 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18640 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18641 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18645 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18646 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18647 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18648 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18651 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18652 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18653 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18654 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18655 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18656 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18657 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18658 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18660 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18661 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18662 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18663 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18664 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18665 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18666 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18667 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18672 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18673 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18674 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18675 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18676 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18677 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18679 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18681 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18685 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18686 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18688 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18689 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18690 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18691 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18692 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18693 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18694 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18695 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18696 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18697 in a &%route_list%&).
18699 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18700 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18701 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18702 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18706 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18707 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18708 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18709 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18710 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18711 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18712 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18715 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18716 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18718 This data can be accessed by setting
18720 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18722 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18723 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18724 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18725 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18726 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18731 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18732 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18733 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18734 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18735 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18736 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18737 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18739 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18740 variables are set during its expansion:
18743 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18744 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18745 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18747 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18750 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18752 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18755 .vindex "&$value$&"
18756 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18757 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18759 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18763 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18764 semicolon is the default route list separator.
18768 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18769 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18770 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18771 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18772 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18773 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18776 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18777 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18778 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18780 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18781 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18784 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18785 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18786 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18787 number follows. For example:
18789 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18793 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18794 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18795 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18796 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18797 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18800 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18801 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18802 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18803 records in the DNS. For example:
18805 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18807 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18810 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18812 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18813 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18814 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18815 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18816 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18817 happens is controlled by the
18818 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18819 &%self%& option of the router.
18821 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18822 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18823 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18824 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18825 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18826 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18827 defined by MX preferences.
18829 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18830 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18831 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18833 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18834 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18835 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18836 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18838 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18839 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18842 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18843 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18844 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18846 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18847 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18851 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18852 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18853 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18854 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18855 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18856 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18857 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18860 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18861 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18863 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18864 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18866 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18867 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18868 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18870 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18871 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18872 timeout), delivery is deferred.
18877 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18878 domain2 host4:host5
18880 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18881 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18882 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18883 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18886 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18887 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18888 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18889 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18894 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18895 &%host_find_failed%& option.
18898 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18899 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18903 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18904 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18905 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18908 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
18909 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18910 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18911 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18913 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
18915 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
18916 your first router something like this:
18919 driver = manualroute
18920 domains = !+local_domains
18921 transport = remote_smtp
18922 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
18924 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
18925 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
18926 they are tried in order
18927 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
18928 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
18931 driver = manualroute
18932 transport = remote_smtp
18933 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
18935 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
18936 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
18937 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
18938 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
18939 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
18940 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
18941 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
18942 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
18945 .cindex "mail hub example"
18946 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
18947 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
18948 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
18949 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
18950 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
18951 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
18952 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
18953 lookup is easier to manage.
18955 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
18956 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
18960 driver = manualroute
18961 transport = remote_smtp
18962 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
18964 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
18965 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
18966 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
18967 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
18968 domain can be used to find the host:
18971 driver = manualroute
18972 transport = remote_smtp
18973 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
18975 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
18976 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
18977 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
18981 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
18982 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
18983 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
18984 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
18985 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
18986 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
18989 driver = manualroute
18990 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
18991 route_list = saved.domain.example
18993 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
18994 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
18995 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
18998 driver = manualroute
19000 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19001 *.saved.domain2.example \
19002 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19005 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19007 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19008 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19009 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19010 the address if the lookup fails.
19013 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19014 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19015 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19016 one way it can be done:
19022 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19023 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19024 return_fail_output = true
19029 driver = manualroute
19031 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19033 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19035 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19037 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19038 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19039 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19041 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19042 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19051 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19052 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19054 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19055 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19056 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19057 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19058 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19059 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19060 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19061 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19062 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19063 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19065 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19067 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19068 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19069 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19070 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19071 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19074 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19075 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19076 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19077 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19078 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19079 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19082 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19083 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19084 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19085 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19086 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19087 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19088 not set, a value for the gid also.
19090 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19091 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19092 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19093 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19094 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19095 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19099 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19100 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19101 before running the command.
19104 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19105 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19106 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19110 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19111 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19112 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19113 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19114 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19117 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19120 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19121 &%no_more%& is set.
19123 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19124 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19125 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19126 included in the SMTP response.
19128 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19129 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19130 included in any SMTP response.
19132 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19134 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19135 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19137 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19138 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19139 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19142 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19143 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19146 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19147 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19149 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19150 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19151 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19152 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19154 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19155 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19156 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19157 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19158 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19160 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19161 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19162 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19163 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19164 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19166 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19167 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19168 variable. For example, this return line
19170 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19172 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19173 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19174 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19175 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19180 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19181 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19183 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19184 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19185 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19186 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19187 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19188 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19189 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19190 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19191 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19192 redirected in several different ways:
19195 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19198 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19200 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19202 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19204 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19206 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19208 It can be discarded.
19211 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19212 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19213 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19214 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19217 If success DSNs have been requested
19218 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19219 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19220 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19225 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19226 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19227 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19228 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19229 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19230 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19234 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19236 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19237 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19238 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19239 cause delivery to be deferred.
19241 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19242 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19247 file = $home/.forward
19250 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19251 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19252 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19253 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19258 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19259 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19260 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19261 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19264 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19265 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19266 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19267 practice the router may not be able to operate.
19269 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19270 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19271 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19272 saves some resources.
19280 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19281 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19282 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19283 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19284 can be interpreted in two different ways:
19287 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19288 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19289 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19290 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19291 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19292 document is intended for use by end users.
19294 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19295 described in the next section.
19298 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19299 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19300 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19301 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19302 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19306 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19307 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19308 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19309 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19310 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19311 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19312 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19313 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19314 commas or newlines.
19315 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19318 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19319 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19320 next newline character is ignored.
19322 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19323 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19324 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19325 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19328 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19329 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19330 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19331 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19332 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19333 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19336 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19340 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19341 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
19342 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19343 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19344 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19345 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19346 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19347 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19348 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19349 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19350 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19352 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19353 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19354 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19355 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19356 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19358 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19360 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
19361 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19362 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19363 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19364 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19367 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
19368 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19369 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19370 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19371 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19373 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19374 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19379 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19380 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19383 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19385 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19386 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19387 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19388 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19389 should really contain
19391 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19393 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19394 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19395 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19399 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19400 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19401 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19404 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19405 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19406 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19407 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19408 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19409 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19410 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19412 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19413 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19414 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19415 in double quotes, for example:
19417 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19419 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19420 quote just the command. An item such as
19422 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19424 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19426 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19427 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19428 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19429 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19430 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19431 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19432 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19433 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19434 an &%accept%& router.
19437 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19438 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19439 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19440 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19442 /home/world/minbari
19444 is treated as a file name, but
19446 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19448 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19449 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19450 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19451 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19453 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19454 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19456 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
19457 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
19458 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
19459 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
19462 .cindex "included address list"
19463 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
19464 If an item is of the form
19466 :include:<path name>
19468 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
19469 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
19470 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
19471 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
19472 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
19473 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
19475 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
19477 It must be given as
19479 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
19482 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
19483 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
19484 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
19485 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
19486 .cindex "black hole"
19487 .cindex "abandoning mail"
19488 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
19489 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
19490 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
19492 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
19493 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
19494 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
19495 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
19499 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
19500 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
19501 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
19502 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
19503 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
19504 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
19505 redirection items of the form
19510 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
19511 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
19512 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
19513 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
19515 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
19517 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
19519 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
19520 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
19522 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
19523 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
19524 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
19526 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19527 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
19528 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
19529 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
19530 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
19531 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
19532 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
19533 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
19534 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
19537 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
19538 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
19539 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
19540 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
19542 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
19543 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
19544 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
19545 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
19546 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
19548 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
19549 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
19550 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
19551 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
19552 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
19556 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
19557 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
19558 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
19559 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
19560 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
19561 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
19562 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
19566 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
19567 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19568 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
19569 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
19570 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
19571 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
19572 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
19573 aliasing scheme of the type
19575 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
19579 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
19580 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
19581 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
19584 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
19585 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
19587 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
19588 the pipes are distinct.
19592 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
19593 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
19594 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
19595 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
19596 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
19597 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
19598 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
19599 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
19600 can be used to avoid this.
19603 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
19604 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
19605 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
19606 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19607 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19608 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19609 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19613 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19615 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19616 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19619 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19620 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19621 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19624 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19625 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19626 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19627 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19630 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19631 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19632 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19633 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19634 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19635 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19636 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19638 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19639 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19642 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19643 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19644 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19645 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19646 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19650 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19651 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19652 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19653 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19654 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19655 let ordinary users do.
19659 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19660 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19661 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19662 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19663 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19664 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19666 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19667 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19668 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19669 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19670 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19671 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19673 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19675 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19676 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19677 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19678 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19679 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19680 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19681 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19682 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19685 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19686 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19687 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19688 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19689 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19690 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19691 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19692 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19696 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19697 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19698 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19699 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19700 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19701 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19704 .option data redirect string&!! unset
19705 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19706 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19707 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19708 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19709 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19711 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19712 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19713 terminated with newline characters. For example:
19715 data = #Exim filter\n\
19716 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19718 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19719 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19720 choice into a newline.
19723 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19724 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19725 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19726 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19727 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19730 .option file redirect string&!! unset
19731 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19732 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19733 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19734 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19735 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19736 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19737 entirely of comments), the router declines.
19739 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19740 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19741 runs a check on the containing directory,
19742 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19743 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19744 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19745 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19746 not, the router declines.
19749 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19750 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19751 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19752 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19753 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19754 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19755 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19758 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19759 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19760 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19761 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19762 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19765 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19766 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19770 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19771 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19772 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19777 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19778 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19779 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19780 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19781 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19782 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19783 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19784 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19785 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19788 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19789 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19790 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19791 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19794 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19795 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19796 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19797 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19799 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19800 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19801 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19802 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19803 &_.forward_& files).
19806 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19807 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19808 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19811 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19812 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19813 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19814 of the embedded Perl support.
19817 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19818 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19819 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19822 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19823 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19824 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19827 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19828 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19829 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19830 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19831 &%one_time%& is set.
19834 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19835 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19836 to make use of &%run%& items.
19839 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19840 If this option is true, items of the form
19842 :include:<path name>
19844 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19847 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19848 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19849 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19850 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19851 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19854 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19855 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19856 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19859 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19860 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19861 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19862 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19863 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19868 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19869 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19870 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19871 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19872 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19873 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19874 bounce may well quote the generated address.
19877 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19879 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19880 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19881 file did not exist.
19884 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19886 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19887 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19888 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19890 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19891 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19892 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19893 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19894 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19895 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19896 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19897 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19901 .option include_directory redirect string unset
19902 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19903 redirection list must start with this directory.
19906 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19907 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19908 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19911 .option one_time redirect boolean false
19912 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
19913 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
19914 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
19915 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
19916 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
19917 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
19918 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
19919 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
19920 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
19921 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
19922 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
19923 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
19924 before they subscribed.
19926 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
19927 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
19928 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
19929 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
19932 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
19933 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
19934 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
19935 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
19937 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
19938 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
19939 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
19941 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
19944 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
19945 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
19946 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
19947 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
19948 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
19952 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
19953 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
19954 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
19955 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
19956 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
19957 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
19958 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
19959 See &%check_owner%& above.
19962 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
19963 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
19964 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
19965 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
19968 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
19969 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
19970 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
19971 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
19972 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
19973 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
19974 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
19977 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
19978 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
19979 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
19980 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
19981 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
19982 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
19983 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
19984 &$qualify_recipient$&.
19986 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
19987 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
19988 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
19991 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
19992 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
19993 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
19994 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
19995 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
19996 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
19997 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
19998 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
19999 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20000 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20003 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20004 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20005 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20006 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20007 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20008 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20011 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20012 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20013 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20014 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20015 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20016 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20019 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20020 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20021 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20022 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20023 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20026 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20027 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20028 :subaddress part of an address.
20030 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20031 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20032 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20033 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20036 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20037 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20038 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20039 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20040 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20041 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20042 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20046 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20047 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20048 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20049 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20050 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20051 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20052 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20053 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20054 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20055 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20056 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20057 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20058 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20059 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20060 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20061 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20063 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20064 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20065 the following routers.
20067 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20068 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20069 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20070 so it is passed to the following routers.
20072 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20073 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20074 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20075 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20077 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20078 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20079 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20080 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20086 file = $home/.forward
20087 file_transport = address_file
20088 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20089 reply_transport = address_reply
20092 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20093 syntax_errors_text = \
20094 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20095 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20096 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20097 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20098 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20099 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20100 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20101 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20102 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20103 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20105 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20106 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20107 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20112 local_part_prefix = real-
20113 transport = local_delivery
20115 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20116 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20118 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20119 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20123 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20124 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20127 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20128 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20129 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20130 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20137 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20138 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20140 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20141 "Environment for local transports"
20142 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20143 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
20144 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20145 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20146 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20147 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20148 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20150 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20151 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20152 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20153 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20155 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20156 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20157 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20158 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20159 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20163 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20164 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20165 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20166 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20167 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20168 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20169 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20172 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20173 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20177 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20179 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20180 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20181 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20182 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20187 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20188 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20189 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20190 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20191 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20192 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20193 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20194 group (set by the transport). For example:
20197 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20201 transport = group_delivery
20204 # This transport overrides the group
20206 driver = appendfile
20207 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20210 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20211 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20212 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20215 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20216 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20217 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20218 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20219 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20220 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20222 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20223 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20224 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20225 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20226 original gid is also used.
20228 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20229 following that is set is used:
20232 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20234 A &%group%& setting of the router;
20236 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20237 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20239 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20241 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20242 the uid is the creator's uid;
20244 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20247 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20248 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20249 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20250 The first of the following that is set is used:
20253 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20255 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20257 A &%user%& setting of the router;
20259 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20264 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20265 &%never_users%& list.
20271 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20272 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20273 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20274 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20275 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20276 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20277 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20278 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20279 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20280 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20283 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20285 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20287 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20289 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20292 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20295 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20297 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20301 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20302 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20303 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20307 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20308 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20309 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20310 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20311 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20312 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20313 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20314 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20315 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20316 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20317 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20318 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20319 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20320 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20328 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20329 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20331 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20332 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20333 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20334 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20335 The following generic options apply to all transports:
20338 .option body_only transports boolean false
20339 .cindex "transport" "body only"
20340 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20341 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20342 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20343 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20344 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20345 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20346 automatically suppress them.
20349 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20350 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20351 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20352 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20353 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20354 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20357 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
20358 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20359 deliveries by the transport or for any
20360 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20361 what you are doing.
20364 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20365 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20366 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20367 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20369 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20370 output, and Exim carries on processing.
20371 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20372 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20373 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20374 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20376 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20377 transport and the router that called it.
20379 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20380 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20381 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20382 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20383 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20384 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20385 safely be resent to other recipients.
20388 .option driver transports string unset
20389 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20390 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20393 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20394 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20395 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20396 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20397 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20398 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20399 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20400 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20401 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20402 resent to other recipients.
20405 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20406 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20407 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20408 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20409 &%user%& (see below).
20412 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20413 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20414 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20415 This option specifies a list of text headers,
20417 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
20419 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20420 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20421 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20422 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20423 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20424 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20426 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20427 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20430 .option headers_only transports boolean false
20431 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20432 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20433 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20434 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20435 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20436 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20437 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20440 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20441 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
20442 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20443 This option specifies a list of header names,
20445 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
20447 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
20448 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
20450 Each list item is separately expanded.
20451 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20452 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20453 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20455 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
20456 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
20460 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
20461 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
20462 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
20463 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
20464 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
20465 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
20466 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
20467 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
20470 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
20473 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
20474 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
20475 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
20476 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
20477 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
20478 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
20479 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
20480 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
20481 change envelope recipients at this time.
20484 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
20485 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
20487 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
20488 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
20489 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
20490 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
20491 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
20492 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
20493 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
20497 .option initgroups transports boolean false
20498 .cindex "additional groups"
20499 .cindex "groups" "additional"
20500 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
20501 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
20502 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
20503 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
20506 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
20507 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
20508 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
20509 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
20510 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
20511 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
20512 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
20513 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
20514 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
20515 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
20516 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
20517 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
20518 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
20523 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
20524 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
20525 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
20526 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
20527 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
20528 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
20529 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
20530 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
20533 local_part_prefix = *-
20535 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
20538 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
20540 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
20541 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
20542 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
20543 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
20544 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
20547 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
20548 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20549 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
20550 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
20551 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
20552 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
20553 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
20554 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
20555 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
20557 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
20558 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
20559 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
20560 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
20562 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
20563 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
20564 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
20567 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
20568 .cindex "envelope sender"
20569 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
20570 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
20571 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
20572 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
20573 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
20574 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
20575 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
20576 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
20577 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
20579 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
20580 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
20582 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
20583 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
20584 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
20585 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
20586 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
20587 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
20588 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
20590 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
20591 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
20592 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
20593 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
20594 &%errors_to%& in a router.
20598 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
20599 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
20600 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
20601 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
20602 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
20603 have easy access to it.
20605 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
20606 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
20607 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
20608 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
20609 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20613 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20614 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20617 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
20618 .cindex "shadow transport"
20619 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
20620 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20621 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20623 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20624 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20625 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20626 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20627 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20628 cause a log line to be written.
20630 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20631 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20632 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20633 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20634 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20637 ST=<shadow transport name>
20639 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20640 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20641 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20642 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20643 headers that some sites insist on.
20646 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20647 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20648 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20649 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20650 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20651 individual users or via a system filter.
20653 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20654 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20655 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20656 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20657 command must be specified as an absolute path.
20659 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20660 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20661 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20662 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20663 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20664 &(pipe)& transports.
20666 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20667 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20668 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20669 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20670 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20672 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20673 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20674 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20675 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20677 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20678 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20679 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20680 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20681 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20682 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20684 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20685 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20686 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20687 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20688 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20689 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20690 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20691 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20693 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20694 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20695 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20696 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20697 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20698 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20699 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20700 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20701 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20702 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20705 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20706 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20707 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20708 which the message is being sent. For example:
20710 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20711 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20714 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20715 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20716 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20718 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20719 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20720 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20723 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20725 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20726 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20727 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20728 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20729 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20730 Exim tried to expand the first one.
20732 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20733 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20734 arguments. Consider this example:
20736 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20737 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20739 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20740 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20742 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20743 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20747 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20748 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20749 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20750 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20751 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20752 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20753 bounced from a transport filter.
20755 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20756 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20757 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20760 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20761 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20762 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20763 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20764 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20765 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20766 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20767 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20768 becomes a temporary error.
20771 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20772 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20773 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20774 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20775 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20776 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20777 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20780 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20781 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20782 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20784 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20785 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20786 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20787 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20789 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20790 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20791 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20798 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20799 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20801 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20803 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20804 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20805 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20806 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20807 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20808 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20809 copy of the message is delivered each time.
20811 .cindex "batched local delivery"
20812 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20813 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20814 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20815 local transport, for example:
20818 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20819 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20820 recipients saves space.
20822 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20823 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20825 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20826 to a scanner program or
20827 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20831 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20832 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20833 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20835 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20836 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20837 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20838 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20839 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20840 to certain conditions:
20843 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20844 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20845 batching is possible.
20847 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20848 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20849 addresses with the same domain are batched.
20851 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20852 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20853 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20854 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20855 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20858 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20859 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20860 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20864 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20865 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20866 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20867 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20868 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20869 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20870 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20873 escape_string = ".."
20875 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20876 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20877 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20879 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20880 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20881 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20882 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20883 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20884 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20886 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20887 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20888 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20889 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20890 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20891 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20892 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20893 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20894 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20899 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20900 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20902 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
20903 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
20904 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
20905 .cindex "directory creation"
20906 .cindex "creating directories"
20907 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
20908 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
20909 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
20910 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
20911 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
20912 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
20913 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
20914 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
20915 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
20916 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
20918 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
20919 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
20920 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
20923 .cindex "quota" "system"
20924 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
20925 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
20926 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
20928 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
20929 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
20930 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
20931 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
20933 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
20934 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
20937 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
20938 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
20939 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
20940 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
20945 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
20946 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
20947 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
20948 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
20949 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
20951 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20952 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20953 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
20954 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
20955 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
20956 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
20957 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
20958 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
20959 operation. There are two cases:
20962 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
20963 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
20964 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
20965 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
20966 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
20967 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
20968 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
20970 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
20971 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
20972 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
20976 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
20977 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
20978 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
20979 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
20984 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
20986 require "fileinto";
20987 fileinto "folder23";
20989 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
20990 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
20991 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
20992 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
20993 way of handling this requirement:
20995 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
20996 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
20997 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
20999 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21003 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21004 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21005 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21007 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21008 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21009 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21010 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21011 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21012 path to the transport.
21014 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21015 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21020 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21021 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21025 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21026 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21027 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21028 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21029 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21030 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21031 delivery is deferred.
21034 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21035 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21036 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21037 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21038 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21039 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21040 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21041 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21044 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21045 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21046 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21047 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21051 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21052 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21055 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21056 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21057 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21058 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21059 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21062 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21063 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21064 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21065 process is running.
21068 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21069 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21070 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21071 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21072 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21073 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21074 contains is significant.
21076 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21077 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21078 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21079 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21080 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21082 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21083 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21084 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21085 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21086 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21087 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21089 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21090 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21091 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21092 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21094 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21095 .cindex "directory creation"
21096 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21097 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21098 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21100 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21101 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21102 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21103 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21104 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21108 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21109 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21110 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21111 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21112 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21115 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21116 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21117 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21118 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21119 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21120 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21121 &%file_must_exist%&.
21124 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21125 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21126 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21127 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21129 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21130 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21131 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21132 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21133 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21136 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21138 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21139 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21140 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21141 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21143 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21145 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21146 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21150 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21151 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21152 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21155 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21156 See &%check_string%& above.
21159 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21160 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21161 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21162 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21163 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21164 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21167 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21168 .cindex "locking files"
21169 .cindex "lock files"
21170 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21171 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21173 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21174 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21177 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21178 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21181 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21182 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21183 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21184 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21185 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21186 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21190 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21191 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21192 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21193 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21194 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21195 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21196 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21197 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21198 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21201 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21202 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21204 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21205 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21206 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21207 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21208 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21209 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21210 delivery is deferred.
21213 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21214 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21215 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21216 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21219 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21220 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21221 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21222 .cindex "locking files"
21223 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21224 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21225 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21226 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21227 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21228 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21229 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21230 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21232 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21233 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21234 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21235 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21237 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21238 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21241 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21243 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21244 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21245 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21247 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21248 local deliveries because of errors of the form
21250 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21253 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21254 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21255 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21256 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21259 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21260 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21261 for details of locking.
21264 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21265 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21266 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21269 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21270 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21271 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21274 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21275 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21276 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21277 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21278 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21281 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21282 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21283 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21284 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21285 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21286 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21287 external source that maintains the data.
21290 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21291 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21292 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21293 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21294 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21295 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21296 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21297 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21301 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21302 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21303 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21304 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21305 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21306 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21307 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21308 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21309 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21310 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21313 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21314 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21315 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21316 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21317 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21318 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21319 calculation. The default value is:
21321 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21323 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21324 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21326 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21328 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21330 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21331 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21332 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21333 directly into that directory.
21336 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21337 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21338 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21341 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21342 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21343 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21346 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21347 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21348 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21349 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21350 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21351 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21352 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21353 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21355 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21356 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21357 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
21358 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21359 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21360 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21361 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21362 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21363 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21364 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21367 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21368 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21369 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21370 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21371 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21372 below for further details.
21375 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21376 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21377 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21380 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21381 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21382 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21385 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21386 .cindex "locking files"
21387 .cindex "file" "locking"
21388 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
21389 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21390 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21391 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21392 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21393 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21394 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21396 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21397 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21398 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21405 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21406 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21407 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21408 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21409 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21410 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21411 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21412 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21414 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21415 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21416 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21417 append messages to it.
21420 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21421 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21422 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21423 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21424 in which case it is:
21426 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
21427 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
21429 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21430 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21432 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21433 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21434 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21435 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
21440 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21441 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21443 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21444 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
21445 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
21446 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
21447 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
21448 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
21449 value, and this option is ignored.
21452 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
21453 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
21454 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
21455 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
21456 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
21459 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
21460 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
21461 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
21462 on users about incoming mail.
21465 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
21466 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
21467 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
21468 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
21469 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
21470 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
21471 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
21472 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
21473 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
21475 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
21476 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
21477 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
21479 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
21480 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
21481 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
21482 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
21483 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
21484 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
21486 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
21487 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
21488 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
21489 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
21492 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
21494 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
21495 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
21496 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
21497 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
21498 system quota failures.
21500 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
21501 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
21502 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
21503 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
21504 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
21505 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
21506 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
21507 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
21508 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
21509 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
21512 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
21513 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
21514 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
21515 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
21516 delivery directory.
21519 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
21520 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
21521 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
21522 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
21523 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
21527 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
21528 See &%quota%& above.
21531 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
21532 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
21533 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
21534 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
21535 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
21536 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
21537 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
21539 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
21540 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
21541 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
21542 the file length to the file name. For example:
21544 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
21545 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
21547 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
21548 number of lines in the message.
21550 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
21551 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
21552 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
21554 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
21557 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
21558 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
21559 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
21561 quota_warn_message = "\
21562 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
21563 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
21564 This message is automatically created \
21565 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
21566 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
21567 a warning threshold that is\n\
21568 set by the system administrator.\n"
21572 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
21573 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
21574 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
21575 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21576 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
21577 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
21578 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
21579 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
21580 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
21584 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
21586 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
21587 percent sign is ignored.
21589 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
21590 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
21591 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
21592 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
21593 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
21594 &'From:'& line, the default is:
21596 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
21598 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
21599 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
21602 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
21603 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
21607 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
21608 .cindex "envelope sender"
21609 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
21610 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
21611 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
21612 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21613 for details of batch SMTP.
21616 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21617 .cindex "carriage return"
21619 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21620 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21621 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21622 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21624 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21625 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21626 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21627 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21628 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21629 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21632 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21633 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21634 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21635 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21636 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21637 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21640 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21641 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21642 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21643 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21644 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21646 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21647 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21648 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21649 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21651 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21652 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21653 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21654 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21655 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21658 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21659 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21662 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21663 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21664 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21665 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21666 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21667 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21668 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21670 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21671 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21672 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21673 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21676 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21677 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21678 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21681 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21682 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21683 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21684 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21685 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21686 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21687 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21688 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21689 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21691 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21692 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21693 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21694 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21699 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21700 .cindex "appending to a file"
21701 .cindex "file" "appending"
21702 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21705 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21709 .cindex "directory creation"
21710 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21711 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21712 &%directory_mode%& option.
21715 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21716 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21720 .cindex "file" "locking"
21721 .cindex "locking files"
21722 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21723 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21724 reliably over NFS, as follows:
21727 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21728 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21729 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21731 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21733 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21734 Unlink the hitching post name.
21736 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21737 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21738 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21739 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21741 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21742 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21743 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21744 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21745 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21746 it before trying again.
21750 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21751 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21752 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21755 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21756 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21757 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21758 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21759 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21760 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21761 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21762 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21763 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21767 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21768 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21769 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21770 delivery is deferred.
21773 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21774 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21775 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21779 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21780 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21781 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21784 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21785 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21786 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21789 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21790 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21791 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21792 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21793 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21794 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21795 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21796 that prevents link following.
21799 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21800 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21801 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21802 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21803 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21806 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21809 .cindex "file" "locking"
21810 .cindex "locking files"
21811 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21812 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21813 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21814 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21815 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21817 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21819 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21820 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21821 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21823 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21824 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21825 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21827 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21828 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21829 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21830 delivery is deferred.
21832 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21833 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21834 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21835 immediately. It retries up to
21837 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21839 times (rounded up).
21842 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21843 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21846 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21847 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21848 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21849 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21850 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21851 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21852 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21853 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21854 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21855 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21857 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21858 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21859 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21860 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21861 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21862 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21863 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21865 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21866 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21867 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21868 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21871 .cindex "maildir format"
21872 .cindex "mailstore format"
21873 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21874 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21875 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21876 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21877 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21879 .cindex "directory creation"
21880 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21881 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21882 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21883 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21884 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21885 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21890 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21891 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21892 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21893 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21894 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21895 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21896 &_new_& subdirectory.
21898 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
21899 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
21900 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
21901 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
21902 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
21903 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
21904 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
21906 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
21907 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
21908 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
21909 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
21910 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
21911 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
21912 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
21913 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
21915 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
21916 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
21917 folders. Consider this example:
21919 maildir_format = true
21920 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
21921 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
21922 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
21923 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
21925 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
21926 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
21927 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
21928 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
21929 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
21930 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
21932 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
21933 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
21934 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
21935 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
21936 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
21938 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
21939 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
21940 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
21942 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21943 .cindex "maildir++"
21944 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
21945 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
21946 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
21947 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
21948 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
21949 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
21950 amount of space used.
21952 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
21953 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
21954 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
21955 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
21956 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
21957 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
21962 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
21963 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
21964 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
21965 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
21966 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
21967 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
21970 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
21971 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
21972 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
21973 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
21974 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
21975 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
21976 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
21977 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
21978 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
21979 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
21980 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
21981 backwards compatibility).
21983 For one common implementation, you might set:
21985 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
21987 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
21989 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
21990 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
21991 &[stat()]& each message file.
21994 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
21995 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21996 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21997 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
21998 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
21999 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22000 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22001 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22002 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22004 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22005 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22006 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22007 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22008 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22009 need to know the quota.
22011 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22012 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22014 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22015 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22016 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22020 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22021 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22022 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22023 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22024 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22025 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22026 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22027 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22029 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22030 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22031 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22032 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22033 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22034 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22036 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22037 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22038 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22039 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22040 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22041 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22043 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22044 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22045 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22046 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22049 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22050 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22051 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22052 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22053 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22055 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22057 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22058 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22059 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22060 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22061 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22068 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22069 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22071 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22072 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22073 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22074 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22075 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22076 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22077 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22078 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22080 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22081 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22082 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22083 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22084 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22087 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22088 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22089 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22090 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22091 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22093 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22094 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22095 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22096 transport is run as a consequence of a
22098 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22099 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22100 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22101 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22102 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22103 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22105 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22106 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22107 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22108 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22110 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22111 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22112 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22113 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22114 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22115 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22116 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22118 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22119 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22120 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22121 the transport defers.
22122 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22123 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22125 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22126 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22127 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22128 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22130 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22131 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22132 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22133 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22134 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22135 problems. They are just discarded.
22139 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22140 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22142 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22143 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22144 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22147 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22148 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22149 when the message is specified by the transport.
22152 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22153 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22154 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22155 string comes first.
22158 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22159 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22160 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22163 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22164 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22165 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22168 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22169 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22170 specified by the transport.
22173 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22174 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22175 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22176 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22179 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22180 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22181 the message is specified by the transport.
22184 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22185 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22189 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22190 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22191 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22192 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22193 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22197 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
22198 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22199 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22200 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22202 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22203 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22204 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22205 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22206 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22207 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22208 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22211 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22212 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22213 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22214 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22215 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22217 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22218 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22219 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22220 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22221 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22222 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22225 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22226 See &%once%& above.
22229 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22230 See &%once%& above.
22231 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22234 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22235 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22236 specified by the transport.
22239 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
22240 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22241 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22242 configuration option.
22245 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22246 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22247 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22248 automatic responses. For example:
22250 subject = Re: $h_subject:
22252 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22253 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22254 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22255 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22260 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
22261 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22262 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22263 the text comes first.
22266 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
22267 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22268 when the message is specified by the transport.
22269 .ecindex IIDauttra1
22270 .ecindex IIDauttra2
22275 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22276 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22278 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22279 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22280 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22281 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22282 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22283 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22285 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22286 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22287 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22288 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22289 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22290 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22294 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22295 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22296 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22299 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22300 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22303 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22304 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22305 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22306 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22307 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22310 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
22311 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22312 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22313 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22314 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22315 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22318 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22319 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22320 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22321 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22322 in its response to the LHLO command.
22324 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22325 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22326 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22327 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22330 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
22331 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22332 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22333 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22338 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22342 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22343 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22347 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22348 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22350 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22351 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22352 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22353 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22354 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22355 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22356 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22357 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
22361 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22362 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22363 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22364 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22365 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22367 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22368 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22369 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22370 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22371 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22372 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22373 that are routed to the transport.
22375 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22376 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22377 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22378 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22379 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22380 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22381 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22385 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22386 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22387 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22389 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22390 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22391 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22392 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22393 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22394 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22395 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22398 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22399 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22400 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22401 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22402 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22407 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22408 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22409 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22410 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22411 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22412 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22413 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22414 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22415 &"local delivery failed"&.
22417 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
22418 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
22419 will be sent as normal.
22421 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
22422 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
22423 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
22424 apply in this case.
22426 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
22427 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
22428 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
22429 a non-existent command may be the problem.
22431 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
22432 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
22433 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
22434 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
22435 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
22436 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
22437 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
22442 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
22443 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
22444 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
22445 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
22446 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
22449 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
22450 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
22451 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
22452 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
22454 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
22455 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
22456 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
22457 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
22458 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
22460 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
22462 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
22463 arguments. You have to write
22465 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
22467 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
22468 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
22469 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
22470 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
22471 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
22472 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
22475 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
22478 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22479 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22480 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22481 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
22482 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
22483 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
22484 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
22485 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
22486 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
22487 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
22489 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
22490 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
22491 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
22492 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
22493 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
22494 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
22495 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
22496 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
22498 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
22499 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
22500 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
22501 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
22502 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
22503 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
22504 control what is done with it.
22506 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
22507 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
22508 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
22509 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
22510 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
22511 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
22512 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
22513 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
22514 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
22515 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
22516 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
22520 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
22521 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22522 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
22523 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
22524 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
22525 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
22528 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
22529 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
22530 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
22531 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
22532 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
22533 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
22534 &`LOGNAME `& see below
22535 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
22536 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
22537 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
22538 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
22539 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
22540 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
22541 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
22542 &`USER `& see below
22544 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
22545 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
22546 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
22547 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
22548 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
22549 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
22550 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
22553 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
22554 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
22555 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
22559 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
22560 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
22561 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
22562 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
22565 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
22566 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
22570 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
22571 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
22572 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22573 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
22574 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
22575 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
22576 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
22577 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
22578 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
22579 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
22580 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
22583 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
22585 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
22586 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
22587 &%use_shell%& is set.
22590 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
22591 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22594 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
22595 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22596 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22599 .option check_string pipe string unset
22600 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
22601 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
22602 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
22603 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
22604 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
22605 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
22606 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
22610 .option command pipe string&!! unset
22611 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
22612 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22613 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22614 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22615 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22616 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22619 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
22620 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22621 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22622 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22623 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22624 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22625 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22628 .option escape_string pipe string unset
22629 See &%check_string%& above.
22632 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22633 .cindex "exec failure"
22634 .cindex "failure of exec"
22635 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22636 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22637 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22638 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22639 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22642 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22643 .cindex "signal exit"
22644 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22645 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22646 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22647 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22650 .option force_command pipe boolean false
22651 .cindex "force command"
22652 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22653 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22654 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22655 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22656 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22657 command. For example:
22659 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22663 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22664 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22665 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22667 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22668 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22669 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22670 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22671 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22672 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22674 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22675 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22677 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22678 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22679 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22680 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22681 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
22684 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22685 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
22686 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
22687 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
22688 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
22689 Only one of them may be set.
22693 .option log_output pipe boolean false
22694 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
22695 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
22696 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22700 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
22701 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22702 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22703 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22704 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22705 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22706 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22707 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22710 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22711 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22712 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22715 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22719 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
22720 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22721 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22722 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22723 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22728 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22729 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22732 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22733 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22734 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22735 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22739 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22740 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22743 .option path pipe string "see below"
22744 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22745 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22749 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22750 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22751 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22754 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22755 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22756 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22757 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22758 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22759 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22760 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22761 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22762 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22765 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22766 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22767 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22768 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22769 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22770 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22771 accept the message is used.
22774 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22775 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22776 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22777 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22778 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22779 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22782 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22783 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22784 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22785 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22786 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22787 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22788 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22792 .option return_output pipe boolean false
22793 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22794 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22795 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22796 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22797 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22798 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22799 of them may be set.
22803 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22804 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22805 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22806 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22807 and &%return_output%& is not set,
22808 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22809 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22810 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22811 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22812 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22813 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22814 and 73, respectively.
22817 .option timeout pipe time 1h
22818 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22819 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22820 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22821 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22822 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22823 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22825 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22826 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22827 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22828 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22829 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22830 delivery to be deferred.
22832 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22833 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22836 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22837 .cindex "envelope sender"
22838 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22839 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22840 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22841 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22842 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22844 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22845 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22846 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22847 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22848 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22849 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22853 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22854 .cindex "carriage return"
22856 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22857 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22858 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22859 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22861 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22862 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22863 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22864 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22865 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22868 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
22869 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22870 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22871 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22872 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22873 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22874 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22875 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22876 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22881 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22882 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22883 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
22884 .cindex "external local delivery"
22885 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22886 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22887 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22888 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22889 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
22890 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
22891 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
22892 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
22893 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
22894 configuration for &%procmail%&:
22899 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
22903 check_string = "From "
22904 escape_string = ">From "
22913 transport = procmail_pipe
22915 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
22916 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
22917 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
22918 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
22919 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
22920 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
22922 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
22926 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
22927 use a shell to run pipe commands.
22930 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
22931 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
22934 local_delivery_cyrus:
22936 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
22937 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
22949 local_part_suffix = .*
22950 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
22952 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
22953 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
22955 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
22956 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
22959 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22960 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22962 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
22963 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
22964 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
22965 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
22966 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
22967 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
22968 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
22969 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
22972 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
22973 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
22977 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
22978 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
22979 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
22980 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
22981 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
22982 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
22983 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
22985 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
22986 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
22987 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
22988 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
22989 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
22990 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
22995 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
22996 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
22997 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23001 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23003 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23004 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23005 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23006 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23007 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23008 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23009 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23010 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23013 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23014 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23015 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23016 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23017 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23018 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23019 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23020 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23021 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23022 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23023 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23024 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23025 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23026 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23028 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23029 and will be removed in a future release.
23032 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23033 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23034 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23037 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23038 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23039 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23040 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23041 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23042 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23043 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23044 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23046 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23047 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23048 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23049 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23050 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23051 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23052 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23053 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23054 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23057 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23059 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23060 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23061 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23062 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23063 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23066 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23067 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23068 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23069 particular connection.
23071 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23072 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23073 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23074 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23076 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23077 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23078 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23080 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23082 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23083 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23085 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23086 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23090 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23091 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23092 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23093 authenticated as a client.
23096 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23097 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23098 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23099 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23102 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23103 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23104 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23105 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23106 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23107 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23108 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23111 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23112 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23113 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23114 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23115 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23116 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23117 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23121 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23122 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23123 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23124 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23127 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23128 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23129 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23132 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23133 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23134 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23135 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23136 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23137 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23139 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23140 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23141 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23142 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23143 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23144 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23145 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23146 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23150 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23151 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23152 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23153 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23154 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23157 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23158 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23159 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23160 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23164 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23165 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23166 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23167 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23168 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23169 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23170 the dnssec request bit set.
23171 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23175 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23176 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23177 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23178 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23179 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23180 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23181 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23182 (AD bit) set wil be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23183 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23187 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23188 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23189 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23190 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23191 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23192 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23193 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23195 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23196 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23197 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23198 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23199 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23202 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23203 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23204 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23205 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23206 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23207 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23208 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23209 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23211 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23212 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23213 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23214 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23215 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23216 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23218 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23219 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23220 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23221 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23222 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23224 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23225 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23226 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23227 copy of the message is sent.
23229 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23230 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23231 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23232 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23236 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23237 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23238 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23241 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23242 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23243 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23244 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23245 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23246 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23248 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23249 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23250 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23251 implementations of TLS.
23253 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23254 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23255 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23256 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23257 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23258 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23259 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23264 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23265 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23266 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23267 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23268 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23269 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23270 interface address, you could use this:
23272 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23273 {$primary_hostname}}
23275 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23278 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23279 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23280 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23281 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23282 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23283 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23285 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23286 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23287 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23288 &%hosts_override%& is set.
23290 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23291 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23292 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23293 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23294 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23295 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23296 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23298 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23299 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23300 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23301 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23302 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23303 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23304 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23307 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23308 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23311 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23312 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23313 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23314 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23315 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23316 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23317 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23318 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23319 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23320 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23323 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23324 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23325 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23326 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23329 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23330 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23331 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23332 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23335 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23336 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23337 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23338 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23339 to any host that matches this list.
23343 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23344 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23345 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23346 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
23347 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
23348 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
23349 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
23350 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
23353 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
23354 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
23355 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
23360 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23361 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23362 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23363 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23364 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23365 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23366 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23367 explanation of when this might be needed.
23370 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23371 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23372 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23373 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23374 &%fallback_hosts%&.
23377 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23378 .cindex "randomized host list"
23379 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23380 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23381 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23382 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23383 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23384 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23385 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23386 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23388 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
23389 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
23390 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
23391 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
23393 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
23395 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
23396 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
23397 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
23399 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23400 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
23401 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
23402 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
23403 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
23404 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
23405 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
23406 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
23407 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23410 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
23411 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23412 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
23413 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23414 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23416 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23417 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23418 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
23419 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23420 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23422 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23423 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23424 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23425 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23426 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
23427 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
23429 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23430 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
23431 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23432 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
23433 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
23434 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
23435 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23438 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
23439 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
23440 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23441 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
23442 for multi-recipient messages.
23443 The option can usually be left as default.
23446 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
23447 .cindex "bind IP address"
23448 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
23450 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23451 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
23452 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
23453 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
23454 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
23455 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
23456 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
23457 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
23460 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
23461 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
23462 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
23463 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
23464 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
23465 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
23467 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
23469 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
23470 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
23471 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
23472 interface to use if the host has more than one.
23475 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
23476 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
23477 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
23478 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
23479 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
23480 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
23481 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
23482 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
23483 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
23484 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
23488 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
23489 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23490 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
23491 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
23492 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
23494 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
23495 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
23496 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
23497 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
23498 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
23502 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
23503 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23504 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
23505 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
23506 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
23507 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
23508 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
23509 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
23512 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
23513 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
23514 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
23517 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
23518 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
23519 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
23520 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
23521 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
23522 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
23523 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
23524 variable that contains an outgoing port.
23526 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
23527 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
23528 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
23529 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
23534 .option protocol smtp string smtp
23535 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
23536 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
23537 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
23539 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
23540 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
23541 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
23542 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
23543 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
23545 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
23546 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
23547 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
23548 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
23551 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
23552 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
23553 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
23554 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
23555 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
23556 addresses is not affected.
23558 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
23559 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
23560 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
23561 Exim to use only the host name.
23563 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
23567 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23568 .cindex "serializing connections"
23569 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
23570 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
23571 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
23572 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
23573 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
23574 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
23575 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
23577 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
23578 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
23579 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
23580 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
23581 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23582 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23584 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
23585 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23586 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23587 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23588 are used for ETRN serialization.
23591 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
23592 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
23593 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
23594 .cindex "size" "of message"
23595 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23596 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23597 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
23598 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
23599 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
23600 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
23601 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
23602 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
23604 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
23605 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
23608 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
23609 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
23610 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
23612 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23613 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23614 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
23615 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
23616 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
23619 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
23620 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
23621 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
23622 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
23626 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
23627 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
23628 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
23629 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
23630 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
23633 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
23634 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
23635 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
23636 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
23637 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
23638 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
23641 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
23644 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
23645 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
23647 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23648 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23649 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
23650 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
23651 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23652 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
23653 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
23654 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23657 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23658 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
23659 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23661 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23662 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
23663 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
23664 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
23665 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23666 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
23667 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
23668 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
23669 ciphers is a preference order.
23673 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
23674 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
23675 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
23676 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
23677 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
23678 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
23679 certificate and private key for the session.
23681 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
23683 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
23689 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
23690 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
23691 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
23692 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
23693 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
23694 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
23695 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
23696 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
23697 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
23698 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
23703 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
23705 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23706 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23707 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
23708 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
23709 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23710 Note that unless the host is in this list
23711 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
23712 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
23713 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
23714 certificate verification succeeds.
23718 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
23719 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
23720 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23721 This option give a list of hosts for which,
23722 while verifying the server certificate,
23723 checks will be included on the host name
23724 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
23725 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
23726 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
23728 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
23733 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
23734 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23735 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23737 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23738 The value of this option must be either the
23740 or the absolute path to
23741 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
23742 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
23744 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
23745 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
23746 is taken as empty and an explicit location
23749 The use of a directory for the option value is not avilable for GnuTLS versions
23750 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
23753 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
23755 either by file or directory
23756 are added to those given by the system default location.
23758 The values of &$host$& and
23759 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23760 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23762 For back-compatability,
23763 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
23764 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
23765 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
23768 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23769 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23770 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23771 This option gives a list of hosts for which. on encrypted connections,
23772 certificate verification must succeed.
23773 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23774 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
23775 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
23780 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
23782 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23783 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
23784 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
23785 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
23786 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
23789 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
23790 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
23791 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
23792 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
23795 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23796 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23797 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23799 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23800 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23801 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23802 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23803 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23805 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23806 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23807 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23808 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23809 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23810 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23811 see below for an exception).
23813 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23814 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23815 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23816 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23817 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23819 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23820 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23821 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23822 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23823 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23824 reached their retry times.
23826 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23827 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23828 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23829 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23830 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23831 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23832 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23833 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23834 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23835 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23838 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23839 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23840 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23841 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23842 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23843 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23845 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23846 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23847 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23848 possible IP addresses have been tried.
23849 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
23850 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
23856 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23857 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23859 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
23860 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
23861 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
23862 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
23863 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
23864 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
23866 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
23867 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
23868 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
23869 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
23870 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
23871 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
23872 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
23874 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
23875 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
23876 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
23877 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
23880 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
23881 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
23882 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
23883 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
23885 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
23886 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
23887 facility; you do not have to use it.
23889 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
23890 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
23891 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
23892 address to which it applies.
23894 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
23895 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
23896 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
23897 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
23898 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
23899 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
23902 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
23903 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
23904 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
23905 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
23908 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
23909 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
23910 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
23911 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
23912 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
23915 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
23916 illustrated by these examples:
23919 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
23920 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
23921 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
23922 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
23924 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
23925 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
23930 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
23931 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
23932 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
23933 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
23934 message's processing.
23936 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23937 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
23938 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
23939 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
23940 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
23941 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
23942 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
23943 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
23944 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
23946 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23947 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23948 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
23949 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
23950 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
23951 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
23952 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
23953 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
23954 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
23955 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
23957 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
23958 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
23959 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
23960 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
23961 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
23962 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
23964 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
23965 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
23966 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
23968 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
23969 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
23970 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
23971 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
23972 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
23973 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
23974 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
23975 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
23976 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
23978 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
23979 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
23985 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
23986 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
23987 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
23988 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
23989 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
23990 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
23991 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
23992 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
23993 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
23994 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
23996 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
23998 might produce the output
24000 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24001 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24002 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24003 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24004 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24005 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24006 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24007 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24009 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24010 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24011 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24012 set for a particular transport.
24015 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24016 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24017 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24020 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24022 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24023 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24024 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24025 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24027 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24028 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24029 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24030 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24033 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24034 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24035 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24037 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24038 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24039 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24040 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24041 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24042 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24043 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24045 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24046 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24047 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24048 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24049 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24053 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24054 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24057 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24058 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24059 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24060 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24061 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24062 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24063 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24064 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24065 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24067 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24068 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24069 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24071 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24072 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24073 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24074 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24075 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24076 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24077 of pattern they are set as follows:
24080 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24081 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24082 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24085 *queen@*.fict.example
24087 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24089 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24093 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24094 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24097 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24098 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24099 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24100 rewriting rule of the form
24102 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24104 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24110 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24111 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24112 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24113 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24114 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24118 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24119 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24120 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24121 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24122 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24124 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24126 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24129 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24130 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24131 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24132 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24133 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24134 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24135 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24136 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24137 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24138 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24139 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24140 entry written to the panic log.
24144 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24145 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24148 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24151 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24153 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24156 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24157 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24161 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24163 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24164 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24165 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24166 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24167 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24168 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24170 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24171 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24172 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24173 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24174 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24175 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24176 &`h`& rewrite all headers
24177 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24178 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24179 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24181 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24182 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24183 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24185 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24186 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24189 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24190 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24191 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24192 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24193 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24194 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24195 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24196 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24197 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24199 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24200 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24201 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24202 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24203 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24204 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24205 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24206 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24209 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24210 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24211 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24212 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24215 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24216 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24217 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24219 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24220 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24221 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24222 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24224 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24225 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24226 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24228 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24229 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24230 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24231 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24233 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24237 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24240 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24241 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24242 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24243 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
24244 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24245 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24246 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24247 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
24249 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24250 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24254 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24255 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24257 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24258 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24259 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24261 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24262 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24263 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
24264 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
24265 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
24266 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
24267 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
24268 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
24270 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
24271 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
24273 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
24275 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
24276 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
24278 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
24279 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
24280 messages that originate outside the local host:
24282 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
24283 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
24285 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
24288 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
24289 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
24290 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
24291 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
24292 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
24293 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
24294 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
24295 components. For example, the rule
24297 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
24299 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
24300 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
24301 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
24302 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
24303 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
24304 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
24305 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24312 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24313 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24315 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
24316 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
24317 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
24318 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
24319 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
24320 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
24321 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
24322 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
24323 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
24324 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
24325 address, domain and error.
24327 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
24328 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
24329 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
24330 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
24331 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
24332 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
24333 log selector is set, the message
24334 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
24335 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
24336 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
24337 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
24339 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
24340 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
24341 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
24342 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
24343 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
24344 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
24345 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
24346 domain are maintained independently.
24348 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
24349 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
24350 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
24351 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
24352 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
24353 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
24354 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
24355 the local address is reached.
24357 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
24358 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
24359 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
24360 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
24361 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
24363 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
24364 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
24365 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
24366 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
24367 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
24368 messages that it should now be retaining.
24372 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
24373 .cindex "retry" "rules"
24374 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
24375 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
24376 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
24377 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
24378 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
24379 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
24380 message's sender, respectively.
24383 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
24384 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
24385 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
24386 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
24387 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
24388 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
24391 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24393 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
24396 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24398 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
24399 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
24402 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
24403 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
24404 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
24405 expressions work in address lists.
24407 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
24408 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
24412 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
24413 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
24414 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
24415 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
24416 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
24417 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
24418 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
24419 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
24420 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
24422 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
24423 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
24424 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
24425 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
24428 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
24429 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
24430 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
24431 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
24432 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
24433 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
24434 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
24435 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
24436 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
24437 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
24442 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
24444 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
24445 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
24446 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
24447 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
24448 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
24449 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
24451 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
24455 and the retry rules are
24457 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
24458 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
24460 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
24461 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
24462 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
24463 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
24464 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
24465 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
24467 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
24468 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
24469 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
24470 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
24472 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
24473 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
24474 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
24476 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
24478 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
24479 textual form of the IP address.
24481 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
24482 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
24483 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
24484 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
24487 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
24488 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
24489 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
24491 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
24492 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
24493 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
24495 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
24496 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
24498 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
24499 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
24502 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
24503 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
24504 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
24505 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
24506 retry rule of this form:
24508 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
24510 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
24511 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
24514 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
24515 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
24516 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
24517 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
24520 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
24521 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
24522 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
24523 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
24524 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
24526 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
24527 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
24529 .vitem &%refused_A%&
24530 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
24533 A connection was refused.
24535 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
24536 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
24538 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
24539 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
24541 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
24542 A connection attempt timed out.
24544 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
24545 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
24546 obtained from an MX record.
24548 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
24549 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
24550 obtained from an MX record.
24553 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
24555 .vitem &%tls_required%&
24556 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
24557 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
24558 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
24561 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24564 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
24565 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
24566 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
24567 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24568 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
24569 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
24573 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
24574 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
24575 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
24576 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
24577 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
24581 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
24582 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
24583 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
24585 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
24586 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
24587 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
24588 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
24589 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
24590 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
24591 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
24593 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
24594 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
24597 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
24598 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
24599 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
24604 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
24605 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
24606 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
24607 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
24608 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
24611 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
24613 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
24615 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
24617 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
24618 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
24621 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
24623 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
24624 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
24625 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
24626 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
24627 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
24629 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
24630 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
24632 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
24634 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
24635 list is never matched.
24641 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
24642 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
24643 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
24644 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
24646 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
24648 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
24649 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
24650 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
24651 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
24652 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
24654 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
24655 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
24656 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
24657 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
24658 The available algorithms are:
24661 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
24664 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
24665 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
24666 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
24668 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
24669 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
24670 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
24671 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
24672 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
24673 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
24674 queue processing times.
24677 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
24678 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
24679 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
24680 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
24681 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
24682 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
24683 interval is found. The main configuration variable
24684 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
24685 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
24686 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
24687 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
24688 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
24690 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
24691 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
24692 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
24693 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
24694 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
24695 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
24698 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
24699 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
24700 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
24701 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
24702 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
24703 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
24704 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
24705 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
24706 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
24707 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
24708 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
24709 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
24711 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
24712 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
24713 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
24714 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
24715 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
24716 deliveries that have been deferred.
24719 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
24720 Here are some example retry rules:
24722 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
24723 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
24724 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
24725 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24726 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
24727 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
24729 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
24730 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
24731 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
24732 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
24733 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
24734 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
24735 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
24738 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
24739 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
24740 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
24741 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
24742 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
24744 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
24745 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
24746 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
24747 were not obtained from an MX record.
24749 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
24750 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
24751 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
24752 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
24753 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
24757 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
24758 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
24759 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
24760 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
24761 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
24762 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
24763 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
24764 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
24765 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
24766 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
24767 failing for the first time.
24769 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
24770 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
24771 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
24772 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
24774 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
24775 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
24776 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
24781 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
24782 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
24783 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
24784 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
24785 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
24786 default retry rule:
24788 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
24790 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
24791 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
24792 failure for the recipient address that counts.
24794 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
24795 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
24796 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
24797 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
24798 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
24800 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
24801 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24802 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24804 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24805 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24806 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24807 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24808 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24809 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24810 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24811 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24813 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24814 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24815 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24816 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24817 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24820 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24821 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24822 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24823 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24824 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24825 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24826 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24827 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24828 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24831 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24832 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24833 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24834 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24835 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24836 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24837 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24838 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24841 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24842 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24843 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24844 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24845 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24846 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24847 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24848 time out the address.
24850 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24851 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24852 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24853 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24854 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
24855 considered immediately.
24856 .ecindex IIDretconf1
24857 .ecindex IIDregconf2
24864 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24865 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24867 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
24868 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
24869 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
24870 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
24871 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
24872 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
24873 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
24874 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
24875 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
24878 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
24879 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
24882 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
24883 the client's EHLO command.
24885 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
24886 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
24888 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
24889 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
24890 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
24891 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
24892 with the AUTH command.
24894 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
24896 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
24897 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
24898 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
24901 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
24902 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
24903 unauthenticated connection.
24906 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
24907 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
24908 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
24909 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
24911 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
24912 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
24913 &`Connected to server.example.`&
24914 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
24915 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
24916 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
24917 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
24918 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
24923 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
24924 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
24925 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
24926 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
24927 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
24928 included by setting
24931 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
24934 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
24939 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
24940 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
24941 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
24942 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
24943 work via a socket interface.
24944 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
24945 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
24946 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
24947 supporting setting a server keytab.
24948 The sixth can be configured to support
24949 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
24950 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
24951 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
24952 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
24953 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
24955 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
24956 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
24957 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
24958 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
24959 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
24960 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
24961 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
24963 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
24964 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
24965 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
24966 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
24967 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
24968 both sets of options, is required. For example:
24972 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24973 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
24975 client_secret = secret2
24977 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
24978 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
24980 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
24981 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
24982 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
24985 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
24986 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
24987 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
24988 authenticating data.
24990 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
24991 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
24992 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
24993 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
24994 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
24995 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
24996 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
24997 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
24998 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
24999 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25002 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25003 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25004 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25005 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25009 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25010 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25011 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25013 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25014 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25015 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25016 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25017 encrypted by a setting such as:
25019 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25023 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25024 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25025 result is used in the log lines for outbound messasges.
25026 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25029 .option driver authenticators string unset
25030 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25031 authenticators is to be used.
25034 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25035 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25036 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25037 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25038 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25039 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25042 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25043 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25044 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25045 mechanism is not advertised.
25046 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25047 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25048 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25051 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25052 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25053 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25056 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25057 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25059 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25060 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25061 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25062 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25063 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25064 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25065 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25066 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25067 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25071 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25072 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25073 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25074 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25075 out the values of variables.
25076 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25077 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25080 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25081 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25082 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25083 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25084 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25085 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25086 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25087 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25088 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25091 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25092 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25093 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25094 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25095 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25096 remembered for later use.
25097 How it is used is described in the following section.
25103 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25104 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25105 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25106 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25107 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25111 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25112 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25114 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25116 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25117 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25118 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25119 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25120 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25121 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25122 given for the MAIL command.
25124 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25125 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25128 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25129 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25130 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25131 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25132 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25133 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25134 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25139 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25140 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25141 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25142 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25144 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25145 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25146 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25147 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25148 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25153 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25154 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25155 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25156 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25160 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25162 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25163 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25166 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25167 the mechanisms are advertised.
25169 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25170 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25171 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25172 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25173 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25174 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25175 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25177 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25179 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25181 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25182 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25183 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25186 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25188 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25189 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25190 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25192 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25193 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25194 command. This is the case if
25197 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25199 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25201 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25202 server authenticators.
25206 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25207 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25208 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25210 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25211 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25212 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25213 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25214 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25215 rejected with a 504 error.
25217 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25218 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25219 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25220 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25221 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25222 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25223 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25224 no successful authentication.
25229 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25230 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25231 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25232 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25233 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25234 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25235 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25239 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25241 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25242 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25243 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25244 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25245 command line to run this script on such data might be
25247 encode '\0user\0password'
25249 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25250 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25251 whose code value is zero.
25253 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25254 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25255 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25256 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25258 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25259 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25260 example, a command such as
25262 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25264 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
25266 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
25267 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
25269 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
25271 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
25272 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
25273 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
25274 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
25278 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
25279 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
25280 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
25281 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
25282 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
25283 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
25286 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
25287 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
25288 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
25289 of the authenticator.
25292 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25293 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
25294 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
25295 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
25296 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
25297 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
25298 delivery to be deferred.
25300 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
25301 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
25302 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
25305 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
25306 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
25307 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
25308 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
25309 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
25310 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
25311 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
25312 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
25313 deliver the message unauthenticated.
25316 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25317 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
25318 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
25319 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
25320 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
25321 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
25322 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
25323 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
25324 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
25325 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
25326 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
25327 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
25328 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
25335 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25336 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25338 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
25339 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
25340 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
25341 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
25342 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
25343 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
25344 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
25345 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
25346 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
25347 connections as you do for login accounts.
25349 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
25350 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
25351 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
25353 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25354 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
25355 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
25357 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
25358 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
25359 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
25362 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
25363 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25364 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25365 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
25366 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25367 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25368 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25370 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
25371 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
25372 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
25373 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
25374 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
25375 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
25376 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
25378 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
25379 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
25380 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
25381 string expansions that also use them for other things.
25383 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
25384 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
25385 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
25387 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25388 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
25389 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
25390 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
25391 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
25392 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25393 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
25394 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
25395 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
25396 string as the error text
25398 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
25399 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
25400 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
25404 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
25405 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
25406 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
25407 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25408 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
25409 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
25410 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
25411 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
25413 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
25414 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
25415 configured as follows:
25419 public_name = PLAIN
25421 server_condition = \
25422 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
25423 server_set_id = $auth2
25425 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
25426 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
25427 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
25428 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
25430 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
25431 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
25432 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
25433 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
25437 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
25439 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
25441 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
25442 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
25446 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
25447 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
25449 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
25450 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
25451 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
25452 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
25453 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
25455 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
25456 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
25457 authenticating clients it could make sense.
25459 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
25460 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
25461 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
25462 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
25463 This is an incorrect example:
25465 server_condition = \
25466 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
25468 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
25469 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
25470 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
25471 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
25472 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
25473 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
25474 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
25476 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
25477 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
25479 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
25480 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
25481 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
25482 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
25483 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
25486 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
25487 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
25488 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
25489 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
25490 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
25491 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
25492 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
25496 public_name = LOGIN
25497 server_prompts = User Name : Password
25498 server_condition = \
25499 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
25500 server_set_id = $auth1
25502 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
25503 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
25504 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
25505 strings are used to obtain two data items.
25507 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
25508 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
25509 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
25510 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
25511 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
25515 public_name = LOGIN
25516 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
25517 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
25520 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
25521 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
25522 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
25523 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
25525 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
25526 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
25527 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
25528 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
25529 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
25530 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
25531 uninterpreted string.
25534 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
25535 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
25536 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
25537 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
25538 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
25544 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
25545 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
25546 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
25548 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
25549 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
25550 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
25551 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
25554 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
25555 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
25556 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
25557 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
25558 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
25559 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
25560 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
25561 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
25562 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
25563 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
25564 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
25565 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
25567 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
25568 splitting takes priority and happens first.
25570 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
25571 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
25572 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
25573 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
25576 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
25577 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
25581 public_name = PLAIN
25582 client_send = ^username^mysecret
25584 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
25585 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
25586 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
25590 public_name = LOGIN
25591 client_send = : username : mysecret
25593 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
25594 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
25596 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
25597 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
25602 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25603 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25605 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
25606 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25607 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
25608 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
25609 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
25610 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
25611 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
25612 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
25613 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
25614 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
25615 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
25616 available in plain text at either end.
25619 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
25620 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
25621 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
25622 authenticator as a server:
25624 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25625 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25626 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
25627 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
25628 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
25629 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
25630 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
25631 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
25632 returned to the client.
25634 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
25635 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
25636 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
25637 numeric variables for other things.
25639 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
25640 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
25641 user name, authentication fails.
25645 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25646 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
25647 server_set_id = $auth1
25649 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25650 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
25651 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
25652 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
25656 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25657 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
25659 server_set_id = $auth1
25661 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
25662 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
25664 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
25665 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
25666 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
25671 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25672 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
25673 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25674 server_set_id = $auth1
25677 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
25678 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
25679 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
25683 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
25684 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
25685 computing the response to the server's challenge.
25688 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25689 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
25690 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
25694 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25695 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
25696 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
25697 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
25698 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
25699 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
25700 send the message to the current server.
25702 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
25707 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25709 client_secret = secret
25711 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
25712 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
25716 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25717 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25719 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
25720 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
25721 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
25722 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
25724 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
25725 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
25727 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
25728 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
25729 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
25730 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
25731 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
25733 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
25734 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
25735 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
25736 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
25738 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
25739 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
25740 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
25741 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
25742 depending on the driver you are using.
25744 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
25745 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
25746 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
25747 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
25748 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
25751 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
25752 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
25753 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
25754 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
25755 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
25756 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
25757 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
25758 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
25761 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
25762 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
25763 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
25764 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
25765 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
25766 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
25770 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
25771 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25772 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
25773 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
25776 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
25777 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25778 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25779 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25783 driver = cyrus_sasl
25784 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25785 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25786 server_set_id = $auth1
25789 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
25790 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25793 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
25794 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25797 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
25798 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
25799 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
25800 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
25803 driver = cyrus_sasl
25804 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25805 server_set_id = $auth1
25808 driver = cyrus_sasl
25809 public_name = PLAIN
25810 server_set_id = $auth2
25812 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25813 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25814 but it is present in many binary distributions.
25815 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25816 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25821 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25822 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25823 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25824 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25825 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25826 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25827 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25828 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
25829 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25830 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25831 authenticator only. There is only one option:
25833 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
25835 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25836 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25837 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25838 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25842 public_name = PLAIN
25843 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25844 server_set_id = $auth1
25849 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25850 server_set_id = $auth1
25852 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25853 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25854 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
25855 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
25856 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
25857 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
25858 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
25859 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
25862 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25863 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25864 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
25865 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
25866 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
25867 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
25868 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
25869 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25870 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25871 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
25872 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
25873 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
25874 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
25875 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
25876 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
25877 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
25878 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
25879 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
25880 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
25881 without code changes in Exim.
25884 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
25885 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
25886 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
25887 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
25888 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
25891 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
25892 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
25893 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
25895 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
25896 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
25897 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
25899 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
25900 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
25901 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
25904 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
25905 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25906 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25907 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25910 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
25911 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25912 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25913 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25918 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25919 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25920 server_set_id = $auth1
25924 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
25925 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
25926 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
25927 the password itself.
25929 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
25930 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
25931 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
25932 if available, else the empty string.
25933 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
25934 else the empty string.
25936 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
25938 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
25939 option to be simply "true".
25942 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
25943 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25944 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25947 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
25948 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25949 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25950 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25953 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
25954 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25955 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25956 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25959 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
25960 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25961 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25964 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
25965 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25966 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
25967 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
25969 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
25970 meanings for these variables:
25973 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
25974 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
25976 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
25977 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
25979 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
25980 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
25983 On a per-mechanism basis:
25986 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25987 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
25988 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25990 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25991 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
25992 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25994 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25995 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
25996 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
25997 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26000 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26001 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26002 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26005 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26006 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26008 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26010 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26011 server_realm = imap.example.org
26012 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26013 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26014 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26015 server_condition = yes
26019 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26020 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26022 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26023 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26024 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26025 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26026 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26027 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26028 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26031 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26032 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26033 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26034 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26036 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26037 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26038 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26039 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26041 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26042 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26043 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
26047 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26048 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26049 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26050 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26052 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26053 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26054 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26055 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26057 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26059 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26060 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26062 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26063 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26064 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26069 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26070 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26072 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26073 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26074 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26075 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26076 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26077 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26078 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26079 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26080 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26081 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26082 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26083 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26084 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26088 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26089 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26091 The server sends back a challenge.
26093 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26094 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26097 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26101 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26102 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26103 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26105 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
26106 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26107 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26108 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26109 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26110 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26111 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26112 for other things. For example:
26117 server_password = \
26118 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26120 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26121 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26127 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26128 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26129 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26133 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26134 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26137 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
26138 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26141 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
26142 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26143 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26149 client_username = msn/msn_username
26150 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26151 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26153 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
26154 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
26160 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26161 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26164 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26165 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26166 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26167 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26168 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
26169 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26170 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26171 authentication based on client certificates.
26173 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26174 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26175 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26176 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26177 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26178 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26180 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26181 for which it must have been requested via the
26182 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
26183 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26185 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
26186 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
26187 and can authenticate the connection.
26188 If it does, SMTP suthentication is not offered.
26190 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
26193 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
26194 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
26196 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
26197 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
26198 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
26199 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
26200 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26201 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26203 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
26204 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
26205 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
26207 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
26214 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
26215 {$tls_in_peercert}}
26216 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
26218 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
26219 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
26220 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
26222 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
26224 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
26225 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
26229 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
26230 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
26231 a connect- or helo-ACL.
26235 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26236 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26238 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
26239 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
26240 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
26241 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
26242 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
26245 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
26246 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
26247 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
26248 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
26249 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
26250 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
26251 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
26252 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
26253 certificates are used.
26255 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
26256 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
26257 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
26258 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
26259 between them is encrypted.
26261 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
26262 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
26263 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
26264 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
26267 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
26268 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
26269 in order to get TLS to work.
26273 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
26275 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
26276 .cindex "smtps protocol"
26277 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
26278 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
26279 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
26280 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
26281 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
26282 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
26283 allocated for this purpose.
26285 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
26286 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
26287 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
26288 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
26290 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
26292 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
26293 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
26294 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
26295 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
26296 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
26299 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
26300 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
26307 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
26308 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
26309 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
26310 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
26311 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
26315 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
26319 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
26320 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
26322 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
26325 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
26326 cannot be the path of a directory
26327 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
26328 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
26330 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
26332 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26333 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
26334 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
26335 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
26336 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
26338 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
26339 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
26340 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
26341 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
26342 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
26343 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
26344 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
26347 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
26348 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
26350 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
26351 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
26352 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
26353 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
26355 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
26356 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
26357 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
26358 implementation, then patches are welcome.
26362 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
26363 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
26364 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
26365 but not the chosen filename.
26366 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
26367 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
26369 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
26370 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
26371 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
26372 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
26374 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
26375 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
26376 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
26377 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
26378 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
26379 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
26380 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
26382 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
26383 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
26384 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
26385 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
26386 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
26388 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
26389 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
26390 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
26391 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
26392 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
26393 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
26395 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
26396 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
26397 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
26399 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
26400 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
26401 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
26402 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
26405 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
26408 # chown exim:exim new-params
26409 # chmod 0600 new-params
26410 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
26411 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
26412 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
26413 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
26414 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
26415 # chmod 0400 new-params
26416 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
26418 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
26419 stalling is removed.
26421 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
26422 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
26423 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
26424 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
26425 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
26426 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
26427 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
26428 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
26429 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
26430 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
26431 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
26433 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
26434 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
26435 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
26436 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
26438 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
26439 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
26440 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
26441 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
26442 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
26445 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
26446 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
26447 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
26448 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
26449 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
26450 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
26451 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
26452 directly to this function call.
26453 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
26454 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
26455 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
26456 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
26459 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
26461 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
26462 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
26463 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
26466 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
26467 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
26468 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
26472 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
26475 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
26476 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
26479 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
26480 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
26482 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
26483 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
26486 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
26487 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
26488 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
26489 not be moved to the end of the list.
26492 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
26495 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
26496 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
26499 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26500 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
26501 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
26502 choice of clients used:
26504 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
26505 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26512 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
26514 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
26515 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
26516 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
26517 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
26518 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
26519 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
26520 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
26521 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
26522 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
26523 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
26525 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
26526 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
26528 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
26529 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
26530 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
26531 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
26532 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
26533 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
26535 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
26536 "Priority strings". This is online as
26537 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
26538 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
26539 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
26540 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
26541 on that site can be used to test a given string.
26545 # Disable older versions of protocols
26546 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
26549 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
26550 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
26551 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
26553 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26554 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
26555 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
26556 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
26560 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26566 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
26567 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
26568 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
26569 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
26570 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
26571 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
26572 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
26573 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
26575 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
26576 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
26577 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
26580 554 Security failure
26582 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
26583 rejected with a 554 error code.
26585 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
26586 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
26587 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
26588 without some further configuration at the server end.
26590 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
26591 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
26593 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
26594 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
26596 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
26597 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
26598 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
26599 that goes with it. These files need to be
26600 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
26601 always be given as full path names.
26602 The key must not be password-protected.
26603 They can be the same file if both the
26604 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
26605 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
26606 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
26607 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
26608 the server's certificate.
26610 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
26611 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
26612 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
26614 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
26615 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
26616 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
26619 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
26620 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
26621 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
26623 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
26625 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
26626 with the parameters contained in the file.
26627 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
26632 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
26633 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
26634 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
26635 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
26641 for a way of generating file data.
26643 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
26644 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
26645 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
26646 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
26647 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
26649 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26650 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26651 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26652 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
26653 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
26654 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
26655 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
26656 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
26657 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
26659 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
26660 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
26661 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
26662 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
26663 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
26664 documentation for more details.
26666 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
26667 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
26670 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
26671 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26672 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26673 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
26674 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
26675 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
26676 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
26677 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
26678 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
26679 expected certificates.
26681 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26683 an explicit file or,
26684 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
26685 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
26687 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
26690 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
26691 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
26692 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
26694 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
26696 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
26698 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
26699 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
26700 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
26701 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
26702 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
26703 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
26704 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
26705 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
26706 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
26707 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
26709 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26710 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
26711 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
26712 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
26714 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26715 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
26716 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
26717 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
26718 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
26719 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
26722 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
26723 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
26724 .cindex "revocation list"
26725 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
26726 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
26727 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
26728 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
26729 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
26730 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
26731 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
26733 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
26734 file from every certificate authority they know of.
26736 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
26737 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
26738 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
26739 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
26740 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
26741 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
26743 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
26744 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
26745 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
26746 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
26748 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
26749 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
26750 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
26751 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
26752 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
26753 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
26754 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
26755 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
26757 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
26758 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.1.3,
26759 support for OCSP stapling is included.
26761 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26762 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
26763 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
26764 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
26765 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
26767 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
26768 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
26769 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
26770 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
26771 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
26774 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
26775 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
26778 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
26779 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
26780 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
26781 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
26782 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
26783 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26785 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
26786 not any of the chain from CA to it.
26788 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
26791 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
26792 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
26793 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
26795 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
26796 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
26797 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
26803 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
26804 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26805 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26806 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26807 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
26808 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
26809 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
26810 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
26811 within the &(smtp)& transport.
26813 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
26814 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
26815 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
26816 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
26817 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
26819 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
26820 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
26821 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
26822 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
26823 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
26826 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
26827 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
26828 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
26829 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
26830 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
26831 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
26832 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
26833 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
26834 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26835 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26838 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
26839 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
26840 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
26841 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
26843 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
26844 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
26846 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26849 depnding on liibrary version, a directory,
26850 must name a file or,
26851 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory.
26852 The client verifies the server's certificate
26853 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
26854 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
26855 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
26856 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
26858 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
26859 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
26860 or need not succeed respectively.
26862 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
26863 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
26864 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
26866 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
26867 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
26868 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
26871 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
26872 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
26873 for OCSP to be relevant.
26876 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
26877 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
26878 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
26879 alternative hosts, if any.
26882 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
26883 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
26884 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
26888 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26889 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
26890 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
26891 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
26892 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
26894 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
26895 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
26896 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
26897 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
26898 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
26899 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
26900 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
26901 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
26902 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
26903 outgoing connection.
26907 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
26908 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
26909 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
26910 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
26911 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
26912 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
26913 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
26914 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
26915 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
26916 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
26919 This is analagous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
26920 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
26923 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
26924 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
26925 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
26926 be of limited use in that environment.
26928 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
26929 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
26930 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
26931 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
26932 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
26934 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
26935 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
26936 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
26937 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
26938 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
26940 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
26941 received from a client.
26942 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
26944 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
26945 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
26946 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
26949 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
26950 &%tls_certificate%&
26952 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
26955 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
26958 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
26959 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
26961 .vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
26965 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
26966 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
26967 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
26968 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
26970 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
26973 When Exim is built againt OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
26974 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
26975 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
26976 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
26978 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
26979 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
26980 built, then you have SNI support).
26984 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
26986 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
26987 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
26988 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
26989 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
26990 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
26991 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
26992 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
26993 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
26994 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
26995 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
26996 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
26998 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
26999 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27000 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27001 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27002 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27003 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27004 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27005 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27006 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27008 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27009 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27010 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27011 information is recorded.
27013 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27014 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27015 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27020 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27021 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27022 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27023 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27024 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27025 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27026 to Apache, currently at
27028 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27030 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27031 links to further files.
27032 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27033 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27034 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27036 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27040 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27041 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27042 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27043 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27044 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27045 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27046 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27047 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27048 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27049 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27050 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27051 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27052 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27054 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27055 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27056 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27057 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27061 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27062 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27063 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27064 with OpenSSL, like this:
27065 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27066 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27068 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27071 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27072 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27073 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27074 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27075 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27076 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27077 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27079 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27080 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27081 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27082 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27083 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27084 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27086 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27087 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27088 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27089 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27090 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27091 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27092 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27093 be a sensible resolution).
27095 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27096 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27097 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27099 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27100 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27101 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27102 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27103 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27104 signed with that self-signed certificate.
27106 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27107 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27108 Open-source PKI book, available online at
27109 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27110 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27111 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27115 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27116 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27118 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27119 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27120 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
27121 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27122 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27123 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27124 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27125 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27126 one very small ACL:
27130 accept hosts = one.host.only
27132 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
27133 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
27135 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
27136 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
27137 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
27138 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
27139 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
27140 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
27141 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
27142 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27145 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
27146 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
27147 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27148 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
27149 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
27153 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
27154 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
27155 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
27156 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
27157 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
27158 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27159 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
27160 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
27161 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27162 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27163 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
27164 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
27165 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27166 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
27167 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
27168 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
27169 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27170 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27171 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
27172 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27175 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
27176 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
27177 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
27178 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
27179 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
27180 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
27181 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
27182 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
27183 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
27184 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
27185 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
27186 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
27187 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
27188 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
27189 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
27190 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
27191 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
27192 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
27193 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
27194 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
27197 For example, if you set
27199 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
27201 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
27202 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
27203 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
27204 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
27205 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
27206 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
27207 testing as possible at RCPT time.
27210 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
27211 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27212 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
27213 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
27214 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
27215 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
27216 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
27217 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
27218 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
27219 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
27220 in any of these ACLs.
27222 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
27223 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
27224 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
27225 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
27226 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
27227 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
27228 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
27229 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
27231 control = suppress_local_fixups
27233 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
27234 run, it is too late.
27236 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27237 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27239 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
27240 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
27241 temporary error for these kinds of message.
27244 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
27245 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27246 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
27247 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
27248 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
27249 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
27250 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
27251 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
27252 &%smtp_banner%& option.
27255 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
27256 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27257 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27258 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
27259 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
27260 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
27261 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
27262 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
27263 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
27265 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
27266 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
27267 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
27268 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
27272 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
27273 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27274 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
27275 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
27276 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
27277 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
27278 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
27279 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
27280 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
27281 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
27283 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
27284 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
27285 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
27286 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
27287 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
27288 associated with the DATA command.
27290 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
27291 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
27292 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
27293 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
27294 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
27297 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
27298 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
27299 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
27300 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
27302 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
27303 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
27304 enabled (which is the default).
27306 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
27307 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
27308 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
27310 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27312 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27315 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
27316 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27317 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27319 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27322 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
27323 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27324 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
27325 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
27326 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
27327 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
27328 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
27331 The ACL test specfied by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
27332 has been recieved, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
27333 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
27334 The test may accept, defer or deny for inividual recipients.
27335 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
27336 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
27337 for some or all recipients.
27339 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
27340 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
27341 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
27342 for this can be disabled when the MAIL-time $smtp_command included
27343 "PRDR". Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
27344 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
27345 will avoid doing so in some situations (eg. single-recipient mails).
27347 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
27348 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
27350 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27351 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
27352 the feature was not requested by the client.
27354 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
27355 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27356 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
27357 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
27358 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, it may only accept
27359 or warn as its final result.
27361 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
27362 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
27363 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
27364 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
27366 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
27367 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
27369 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
27370 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
27373 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
27374 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
27375 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
27376 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
27377 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
27380 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
27381 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
27382 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
27383 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
27384 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
27385 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
27386 situation even worse.
27388 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
27389 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
27390 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
27393 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
27394 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
27395 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
27396 connection. The possible values are:
27398 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
27399 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
27400 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
27401 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
27402 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
27403 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
27404 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
27405 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
27406 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
27407 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
27409 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
27410 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
27411 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
27412 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
27413 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
27417 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
27418 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
27419 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
27420 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
27422 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
27423 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
27425 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
27426 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
27427 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
27428 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
27429 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
27431 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
27432 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
27433 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
27436 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
27437 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
27438 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
27439 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
27440 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
27441 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
27443 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
27444 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
27445 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
27447 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
27448 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
27449 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
27450 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
27452 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
27453 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
27454 matches the string.
27456 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
27457 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
27458 want to have something like
27460 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
27462 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
27463 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
27469 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
27470 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
27471 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
27472 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
27473 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
27474 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
27475 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
27476 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
27477 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
27479 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
27480 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
27481 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
27484 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
27485 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
27486 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
27487 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
27489 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
27490 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
27491 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
27492 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
27493 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
27494 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
27495 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
27498 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
27499 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
27500 recipients; it may create new recipients.
27504 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
27505 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
27506 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
27507 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
27508 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
27509 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
27511 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
27512 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
27513 used to accept or reject anything.
27515 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
27516 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
27517 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
27518 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
27520 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
27521 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
27522 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
27523 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
27524 configuration file.
27529 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
27530 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
27532 .vindex &$local_part$&
27533 .vindex &$sender_address$&
27534 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
27535 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27536 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
27537 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
27538 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
27539 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
27540 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
27541 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27543 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
27544 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
27545 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
27548 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
27549 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
27550 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
27551 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
27552 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
27555 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
27556 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
27557 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
27558 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
27559 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
27560 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
27561 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
27562 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
27568 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
27569 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
27570 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
27571 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27572 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
27573 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
27574 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27575 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
27576 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
27577 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
27578 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
27579 unencrypted connections.
27582 accept encrypted = *
27583 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
27585 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
27587 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
27588 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
27589 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
27590 option to do this.)
27594 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
27595 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
27596 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
27597 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
27598 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
27599 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
27600 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
27602 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
27603 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
27604 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
27607 deny dnslists = list1.example
27608 dnslists = list2.example
27610 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
27611 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
27612 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
27613 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
27614 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
27617 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
27618 The ACL verbs are as follows:
27621 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
27622 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
27623 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
27624 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
27625 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
27626 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
27627 check a RCPT command:
27629 accept domains = +local_domains
27633 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
27634 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
27635 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
27636 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
27639 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
27640 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
27641 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
27644 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
27645 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
27646 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
27647 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
27648 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
27649 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
27651 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
27652 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
27654 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
27655 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
27656 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
27658 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
27659 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
27660 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
27665 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
27666 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
27667 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
27668 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
27669 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
27670 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
27671 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
27675 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
27676 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
27677 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
27680 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27682 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
27686 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
27687 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
27688 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
27689 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
27690 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
27691 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
27692 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
27693 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
27694 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
27696 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
27697 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
27698 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
27702 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
27703 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
27704 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
27706 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
27707 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
27709 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
27710 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
27713 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
27714 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
27715 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
27716 example, when checking a RCPT command,
27718 require message = Sender did not verify
27721 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
27722 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
27723 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
27724 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
27727 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27728 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
27729 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
27730 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
27731 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
27732 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
27733 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
27735 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
27736 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
27737 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
27738 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
27739 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27741 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
27742 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
27743 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
27744 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
27745 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
27746 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
27750 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27751 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
27752 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
27753 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
27755 warn !verify = sender
27756 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
27760 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
27762 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
27763 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
27764 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
27765 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
27766 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
27770 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
27771 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
27772 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
27773 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
27774 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
27775 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
27776 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
27777 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
27778 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
27779 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
27781 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
27782 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
27783 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
27784 on the same SMTP connection.
27786 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
27787 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
27788 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
27791 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
27792 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
27793 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
27795 accept hosts = whatever
27796 set acl_m4 = some value
27797 accept authenticated = *
27798 set acl_c_auth = yes
27800 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
27801 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
27802 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
27804 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
27805 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
27806 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
27807 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
27808 error is generated.
27810 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
27811 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
27814 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
27815 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
27816 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
27817 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
27819 deny domains = *.dom.example
27820 !verify = recipient
27822 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
27823 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
27824 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
27825 two statements are equivalent:
27827 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
27828 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
27830 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
27831 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
27833 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
27834 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
27835 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
27837 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27838 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
27839 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27840 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
27842 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
27843 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
27844 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
27845 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
27846 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
27847 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
27848 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
27850 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
27851 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
27852 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
27853 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
27854 message is handled.
27856 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
27857 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
27858 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
27859 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
27861 require message = Can't verify sender
27863 message = Can't verify recipient
27865 message = This message cannot be used
27867 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
27868 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
27869 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
27870 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
27871 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
27872 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
27874 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
27875 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
27876 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
27877 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
27880 !senders = *@my.domain.example
27881 message = Invalid sender from client host
27883 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
27884 by which time Exim has set up the message.
27888 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
27889 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
27890 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
27893 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27894 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
27895 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
27896 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27898 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27899 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
27900 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
27901 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
27902 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
27903 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
27904 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
27905 write rather ugly lines like this:
27907 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
27909 Instead, all you need is
27911 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
27914 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27915 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
27916 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
27917 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
27918 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
27919 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
27920 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
27921 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
27923 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
27924 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
27925 in several different ways. For example:
27927 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
27928 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
27929 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
27933 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
27935 accept ...some conditions
27936 control = queue_only
27938 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
27939 other words, when the conditions are all true.
27942 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
27944 accept ...some conditions...
27945 control = queue_only
27946 ...some more conditions...
27948 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
27949 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
27950 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
27954 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
27955 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
27958 warn ...some conditions...
27962 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
27963 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
27967 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
27968 &%require%& verb. For example:
27970 require control = no_multiline_responses
27974 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
27975 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
27977 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
27978 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
27979 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
27980 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
27981 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
27982 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
27984 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
27987 deny ...some conditions...
27990 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
27991 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
27994 ...some conditions...
27996 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
27997 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
27999 warn ...some conditions...
28005 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
28006 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
28007 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
28008 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
28009 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
28010 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
28011 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
28015 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
28016 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
28017 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28018 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28019 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28020 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28021 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28024 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28025 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28026 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28027 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28029 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28030 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28032 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28035 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28036 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28038 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28039 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28040 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28043 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28044 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28045 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28046 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28047 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28048 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28051 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28052 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28053 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28056 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28057 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28058 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28059 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28060 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28061 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28063 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28064 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28065 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28066 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28067 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28068 logging rejections.
28071 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28072 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28073 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28074 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28075 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28076 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28077 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28078 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28080 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28081 &` log_reject_target =`&
28083 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28084 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28088 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28089 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28090 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28091 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28092 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28093 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28094 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28097 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28098 &` control = freeze`&
28099 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28101 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28102 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28103 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28106 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28107 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28111 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28112 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28113 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28114 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
28115 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
28116 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
28117 &%accept%& for details.)
28119 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
28120 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
28121 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
28122 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
28123 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
28125 require message = Host not recognized
28128 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
28131 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
28132 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
28133 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
28134 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
28135 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
28136 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
28137 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
28138 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
28139 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
28142 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
28143 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
28144 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
28146 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
28147 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
28149 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
28150 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
28151 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
28154 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
28155 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
28157 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
28158 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
28159 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
28162 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28163 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
28164 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
28166 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
28167 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
28168 However, the original message is available in the variable
28169 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
28170 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
28171 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
28172 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
28174 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
28175 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
28176 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
28177 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
28178 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
28179 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
28183 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28184 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
28185 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
28186 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
28189 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
28190 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
28191 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
28192 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
28195 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
28196 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
28197 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
28198 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
28199 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
28200 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
28201 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
28202 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
28205 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
28206 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
28213 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
28214 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28215 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
28218 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
28219 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
28220 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
28221 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
28222 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
28223 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
28224 not work without it. For example:
28226 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
28227 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
28229 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
28230 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
28231 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
28232 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
28233 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
28236 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
28237 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
28238 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
28239 .cindex "case of local parts"
28240 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
28241 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
28242 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
28243 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
28244 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
28245 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
28248 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
28249 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
28250 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
28251 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
28252 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
28254 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
28255 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
28258 warn control = caseful_local_part
28259 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
28261 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
28263 control = caselower_local_part
28265 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
28266 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
28269 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
28270 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
28271 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
28272 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
28274 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
28275 If enabled for a message recieved via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
28276 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
28277 is used for all recipients of the message,
28278 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
28279 and data is copied from one to the other.
28281 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
28282 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
28283 If a recipient-verify callout connection is subsequently
28284 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
28285 any subsequent receipients and the data,
28286 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
28288 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
28289 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
28290 Note also that headers cannot be
28291 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
28292 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
28294 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
28295 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
28296 before the entire message has been received from the source.
28297 It is not supported for messages recieved with the SMTP PRDR option in use.
28299 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
28300 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
28301 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
28302 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
28303 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
28304 before the acceptance "<=" line.
28306 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
28308 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
28311 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
28312 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
28313 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
28314 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
28315 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
28316 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
28317 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
28318 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
28319 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
28323 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
28324 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
28325 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
28329 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
28330 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
28331 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
28332 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
28333 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
28336 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
28337 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
28338 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
28339 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
28340 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
28341 strings or to numeric value.
28342 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
28343 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
28344 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
28346 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
28347 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
28348 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
28349 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
28350 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
28353 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
28354 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
28355 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
28356 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
28357 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
28358 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
28359 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
28360 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
28362 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
28363 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
28364 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
28365 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
28366 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
28367 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
28371 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
28372 .cindex "fake defer"
28373 .cindex "defer, fake"
28374 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
28375 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
28376 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
28377 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
28378 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
28380 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
28381 .cindex "fake rejection"
28382 .cindex "rejection, fake"
28383 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
28384 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
28385 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
28386 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
28387 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28388 the same SMTP connection.
28390 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
28391 message is supplied, the following is used:
28393 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
28394 550-kept for evaluation.
28395 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
28396 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
28398 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
28400 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
28401 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
28402 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28403 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28404 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
28405 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
28408 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
28409 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
28410 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
28411 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
28413 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
28414 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
28415 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
28416 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28417 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
28418 disables such output flushing.
28420 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
28421 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28422 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
28423 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28424 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
28425 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
28427 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
28428 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
28429 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
28430 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
28431 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
28432 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
28433 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28434 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
28435 to be useful in production.
28437 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
28438 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
28439 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
28440 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
28441 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
28443 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
28444 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
28445 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
28446 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
28447 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
28448 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
28451 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
28452 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
28453 verification failed"&) is sent.
28455 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
28459 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
28460 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
28462 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
28463 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
28464 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
28465 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
28466 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
28467 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
28468 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
28470 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
28471 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
28472 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
28473 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28474 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28475 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
28476 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
28477 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
28478 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
28479 same SMTP connection.
28481 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
28482 .cindex "message" "submission"
28483 .cindex "submission mode"
28484 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
28485 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
28486 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
28487 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
28488 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
28489 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
28490 late (the message has already been created).
28492 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
28493 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
28494 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
28495 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
28496 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
28498 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
28499 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
28500 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
28501 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
28502 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
28505 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
28506 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
28508 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
28510 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
28513 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
28514 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
28515 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28516 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
28519 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
28520 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
28524 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
28525 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
28528 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
28530 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
28531 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
28533 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
28535 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
28540 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
28541 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
28542 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
28543 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
28544 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
28545 to an incoming message, as in this example:
28547 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28548 dialup.mail-abuse.org
28549 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
28551 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28552 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28553 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28554 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
28555 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
28558 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
28559 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28561 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
28562 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
28563 contains one or more newlines that
28564 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
28565 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
28566 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
28568 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28569 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28570 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
28571 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
28572 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
28573 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
28574 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
28575 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
28576 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
28577 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
28578 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
28580 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
28581 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
28583 until they are added to the
28584 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
28585 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
28586 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
28587 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
28588 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
28589 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
28590 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28592 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
28594 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28595 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28597 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28598 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28600 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28601 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28603 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
28604 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
28605 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
28606 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
28609 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28610 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
28611 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
28612 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
28613 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
28614 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
28615 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
28618 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
28619 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
28620 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
28621 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
28622 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
28624 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
28625 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
28626 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
28627 to be a header name first.) For example:
28629 warn add_header = \
28630 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
28632 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
28633 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
28634 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
28635 up in reverse order.
28637 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28638 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
28639 system filter or in a router or transport.
28643 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
28644 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
28645 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
28646 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
28647 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
28648 from an incoming message, as in this example:
28650 warn message = Remove internal headers
28651 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28653 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28654 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28655 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28656 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
28657 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
28658 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
28660 Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
28661 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28663 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
28664 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
28665 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
28666 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
28667 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
28669 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
28670 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28671 warn message = Remove internal headers
28672 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
28674 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28675 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28676 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
28677 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
28678 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
28679 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
28680 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
28681 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
28682 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
28683 would have been removed.
28685 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
28686 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
28687 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
28688 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
28689 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
28690 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
28691 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
28692 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
28693 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28695 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28696 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28698 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
28699 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28701 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28702 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
28704 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
28705 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
28706 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
28707 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
28710 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28711 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
28712 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
28717 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
28718 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
28719 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
28720 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
28721 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
28722 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28724 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
28725 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
28726 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
28727 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
28728 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
28729 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
28730 The conditions are as follows:
28734 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
28735 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
28736 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
28737 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
28738 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
28739 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
28740 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
28741 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
28742 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
28743 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
28744 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
28745 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
28747 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
28748 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
28749 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
28750 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
28751 The name and values are expanded separately.
28752 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
28753 will act as argument separators.
28755 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
28756 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
28757 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
28758 conditions are tested.
28760 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
28761 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
28762 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
28763 for different local users or different local domains.
28765 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28766 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
28767 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
28768 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
28769 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
28770 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
28771 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
28776 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
28777 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
28778 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
28779 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
28780 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
28781 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
28782 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
28783 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
28784 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
28785 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
28786 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
28787 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
28790 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
28791 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
28792 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28793 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28794 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
28795 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
28796 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
28797 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28799 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
28800 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
28801 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28802 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
28803 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
28805 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
28806 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
28807 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28808 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
28809 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28810 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
28811 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
28812 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
28813 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
28814 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
28816 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28817 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
28818 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
28819 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
28820 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
28821 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
28822 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
28823 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
28824 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
28827 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
28828 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
28831 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28832 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
28833 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
28834 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
28835 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
28836 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
28837 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
28843 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
28844 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
28845 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
28846 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
28847 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
28848 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
28849 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
28851 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28853 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
28854 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
28855 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
28857 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
28858 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
28859 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
28860 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
28861 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
28862 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
28864 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
28865 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
28867 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28868 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
28870 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
28871 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
28872 statement can then check the IP address.
28874 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
28875 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
28876 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
28877 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
28879 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
28880 message = $host_data
28882 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
28884 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
28885 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
28886 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
28887 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
28888 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
28889 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
28890 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
28891 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
28892 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
28893 the next &%local_parts%& test.
28895 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
28896 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
28897 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
28898 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
28899 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28900 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
28901 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28903 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
28904 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
28905 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
28906 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28907 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28908 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
28909 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
28912 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
28913 .cindex "rate limiting"
28914 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
28915 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
28917 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
28918 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
28919 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
28920 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
28921 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
28922 recipient address against a list of recipients.
28924 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
28925 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
28926 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
28927 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28928 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
28929 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
28930 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28932 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28933 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
28934 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
28935 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
28936 .vindex "&$domain$&"
28937 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
28938 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
28939 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
28940 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
28941 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
28942 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
28943 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
28944 influence the sender checking.
28946 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
28947 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
28949 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
28950 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
28951 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
28952 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
28953 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
28954 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
28958 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
28959 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
28961 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
28962 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
28963 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
28964 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28965 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
28966 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28968 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
28969 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28970 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28971 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28972 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
28973 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
28974 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
28975 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
28976 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
28977 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28979 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
28980 .cindex "CSA verification"
28981 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
28982 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
28983 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
28985 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
28986 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28987 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
28988 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
28989 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
28990 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28991 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28992 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
28993 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
28994 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
28996 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
28997 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
28998 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
29000 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
29001 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29002 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
29003 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
29004 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
29005 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
29006 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29007 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29008 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
29009 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
29010 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
29011 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
29012 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
29013 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
29014 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
29016 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
29017 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29018 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29019 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29022 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29023 !verify = header_sender
29026 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29027 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29028 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29029 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29030 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29031 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29032 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29033 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29034 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29035 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29036 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29037 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29040 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29041 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29045 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29046 common as they used to be.
29048 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29049 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29050 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29051 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29052 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29053 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29054 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29055 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29056 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29057 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29058 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29059 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29060 independently of this condition.
29062 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29063 option), this condition is always true.
29066 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29067 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29068 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29069 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29070 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29071 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29072 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29073 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29074 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29076 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
29077 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
29080 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
29081 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29082 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
29083 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
29084 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
29085 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29086 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
29087 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
29088 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
29089 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
29090 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
29091 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
29092 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
29093 value for the child address.
29095 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
29096 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29097 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
29098 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
29099 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
29100 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
29101 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
29102 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
29103 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
29104 original IP address.
29106 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
29107 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
29109 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
29110 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
29112 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
29113 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29114 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
29115 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
29116 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
29117 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
29118 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
29119 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
29120 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
29122 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29123 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
29124 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
29125 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
29126 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
29127 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
29128 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
29130 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
29131 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
29132 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
29134 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
29135 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29136 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
29137 verified as a sender.
29142 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
29143 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29144 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29145 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29146 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
29147 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
29148 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
29149 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
29150 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
29151 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
29153 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
29154 dialups.mail-abuse.org
29156 the following records are looked up:
29158 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29159 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
29161 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
29162 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
29163 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
29164 use two separate conditions:
29166 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29167 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29169 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
29170 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
29171 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
29174 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
29175 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
29176 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
29177 following special items in the list:
29179 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
29180 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
29181 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
29183 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
29184 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
29185 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
29186 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
29188 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
29190 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
29191 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
29193 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29194 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
29195 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29197 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
29198 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
29199 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
29200 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
29204 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
29205 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
29206 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
29207 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
29208 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
29210 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
29212 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
29213 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
29214 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
29215 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
29220 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
29221 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
29222 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
29223 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
29224 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
29225 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
29226 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
29228 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
29229 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29231 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
29232 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
29233 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
29234 up by this example is
29236 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
29238 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
29239 addresses. For example:
29241 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29242 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29244 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
29245 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
29250 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
29251 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
29252 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
29253 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
29254 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
29255 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
29256 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
29257 either to double the separators like this:
29259 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
29261 or to change the separator character, like this:
29263 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
29265 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
29266 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
29267 occurs. Consider this condition:
29269 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
29271 The DNS lookups that occur are:
29273 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
29274 a.domain.black.list.tld
29276 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
29277 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
29278 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
29279 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
29280 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
29281 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
29282 error for a previous item.
29284 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
29285 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
29287 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
29288 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
29290 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
29291 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
29293 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
29294 $sender_address_domain \
29295 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
29297 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
29298 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
29299 $sender_address_domain} }} }
29301 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
29302 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
29303 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
29304 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
29306 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
29308 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
29309 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
29311 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
29312 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
29317 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
29318 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
29319 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
29320 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
29321 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
29322 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
29326 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
29328 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
29329 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
29330 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
29332 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
29333 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
29334 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
29337 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
29338 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
29339 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
29340 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
29341 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
29342 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
29343 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
29344 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
29345 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
29346 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
29347 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
29348 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
29349 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
29350 cases, for example:
29352 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
29354 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
29355 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
29356 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
29357 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
29359 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
29361 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
29362 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
29364 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
29365 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
29366 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
29367 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
29368 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
29371 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
29372 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
29373 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
29375 deny hosts = !+local_networks
29376 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
29378 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
29383 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
29384 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
29385 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
29386 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
29389 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
29391 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
29392 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
29393 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
29394 describes how multiple records are handled.
29396 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
29397 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
29398 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
29400 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29402 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
29403 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
29404 first. For example:
29406 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
29407 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
29410 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
29411 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
29412 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
29413 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
29414 tested. For example:
29416 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
29418 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
29419 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
29420 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
29422 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29424 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
29429 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
29430 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
29433 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29435 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29436 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
29438 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29440 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29441 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
29442 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
29443 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
29445 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
29446 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
29448 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
29449 previous example is precisely equivalent to
29451 deny dnslists = a.b.c
29452 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29454 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
29455 Consider this example:
29457 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29459 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
29462 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
29464 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29466 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
29467 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
29468 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
29470 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
29475 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
29476 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
29477 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
29478 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
29479 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
29480 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
29482 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
29484 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
29485 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
29486 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
29487 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
29488 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
29489 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
29492 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
29493 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
29494 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29496 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
29497 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
29500 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
29502 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29503 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
29505 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
29507 for the condition to be true.
29510 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
29511 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
29513 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
29514 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
29516 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
29518 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29519 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29521 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
29522 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
29524 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
29526 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29527 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
29529 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29531 for the condition to be false.
29533 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
29534 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
29539 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
29540 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
29541 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
29542 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
29543 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
29544 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
29545 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
29546 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
29547 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
29550 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
29551 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
29552 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
29553 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
29554 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
29555 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
29556 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
29559 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
29560 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
29562 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
29563 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29565 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
29566 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
29567 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
29568 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
29569 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
29570 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
29572 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
29573 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
29574 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
29576 reject dnslists = \
29577 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
29578 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
29579 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
29580 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29582 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
29583 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
29584 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
29588 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
29589 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
29590 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
29591 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
29592 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
29593 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
29595 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
29596 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29598 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
29599 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
29600 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
29602 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
29604 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
29605 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
29607 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
29608 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
29610 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
29611 dnslists = some.list.example
29614 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
29615 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
29616 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
29618 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
29621 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
29622 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
29623 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
29624 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
29625 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
29626 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
29627 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
29628 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
29629 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
29630 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
29632 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
29634 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
29635 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
29637 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
29638 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
29639 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
29642 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
29643 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
29644 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
29645 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
29646 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
29647 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
29648 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
29649 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
29650 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
29652 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
29653 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
29654 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
29655 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
29657 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
29658 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
29659 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
29660 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
29661 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
29662 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
29663 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
29664 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
29665 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
29666 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
29668 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
29669 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
29670 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
29673 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
29674 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
29675 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
29676 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
29677 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
29678 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
29680 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
29681 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
29682 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
29683 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
29684 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
29685 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
29686 the &%count=%& option.
29689 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
29690 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
29691 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
29692 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
29693 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
29695 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
29696 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
29697 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
29698 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
29700 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
29701 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
29702 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
29703 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
29704 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
29705 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
29706 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
29708 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
29709 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29710 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
29711 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
29712 ACLs the rate is updated with the total recipient count in one go. Note that
29713 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
29714 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
29716 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
29717 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
29718 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
29719 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
29722 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
29723 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
29724 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
29725 multiple different commands.
29727 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
29728 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
29729 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
29730 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
29731 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
29733 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
29736 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
29737 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
29738 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
29739 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
29740 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
29742 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
29743 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
29745 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
29746 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
29747 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
29748 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
29752 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
29753 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29754 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29757 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
29758 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29759 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29762 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
29763 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
29764 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
29765 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
29766 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
29767 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
29770 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
29771 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
29772 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
29773 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
29774 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
29777 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
29778 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
29779 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
29780 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
29781 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
29782 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
29785 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
29786 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
29787 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
29788 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
29789 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
29790 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
29791 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
29792 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
29793 from getting any email through.
29795 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
29796 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
29797 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
29798 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
29799 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
29800 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
29801 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
29802 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
29804 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
29808 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
29809 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
29810 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
29811 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
29812 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
29813 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
29814 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
29815 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
29816 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
29818 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
29819 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
29820 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
29821 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
29822 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
29823 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
29825 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
29826 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
29829 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
29830 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
29831 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
29832 required increases with larger limits.
29834 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
29835 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
29836 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
29837 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
29838 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
29839 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
29840 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
29841 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
29842 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
29846 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
29847 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
29848 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
29849 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
29850 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
29851 message. For example:
29853 # Log all senders' rates
29854 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
29855 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
29857 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
29858 # at the decimal point.
29859 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
29860 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
29861 $sender_rate_limit }s
29863 # Keep authenticated users under control
29864 deny authenticated = *
29865 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
29867 # System-wide rate limit
29868 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
29869 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
29871 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
29872 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
29873 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
29874 messages per $sender_rate_period
29875 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
29876 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
29877 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
29879 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
29880 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
29881 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
29882 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
29883 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
29884 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
29885 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
29889 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
29890 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
29891 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
29892 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
29893 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
29894 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
29895 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
29896 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
29897 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
29899 verify = sender/callout
29900 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
29902 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
29903 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
29904 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
29905 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
29906 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
29907 The available options are as follows:
29910 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
29911 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
29912 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
29914 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
29915 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
29916 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
29917 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
29919 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
29920 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
29922 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
29923 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
29924 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
29925 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
29928 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
29929 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
29930 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
29931 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29932 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
29933 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
29936 warn !verify = sender
29937 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
29939 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
29940 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
29941 verification failure.
29943 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
29944 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
29947 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
29948 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
29950 &%route%&: Routing failed.
29952 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
29953 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
29954 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
29956 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
29958 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
29961 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
29962 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
29967 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
29968 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
29969 .cindex "callout" "verification"
29970 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
29971 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
29972 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
29973 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
29974 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
29975 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
29976 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
29977 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
29978 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
29981 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
29982 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
29983 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
29984 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
29985 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
29986 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
29988 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
29989 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
29990 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
29991 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
29992 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
29994 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
29995 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
29996 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
29997 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
29998 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
29999 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
30000 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
30001 supplies a host list.
30002 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
30004 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
30005 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
30006 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
30007 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
30008 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
30009 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
30010 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
30012 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
30013 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
30014 following SMTP commands are sent:
30016 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
30018 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30021 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30024 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30027 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30028 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30029 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30030 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30031 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30032 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30034 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30035 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30036 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30037 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30038 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30040 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30041 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30042 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30043 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30044 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30049 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30050 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30051 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30052 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30054 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30056 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30057 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30058 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30062 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30063 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30064 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
30067 verify = sender/callout=5s
30069 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
30070 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
30071 the &%connect%& parameter.
30074 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30075 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
30076 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
30077 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
30079 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
30081 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
30083 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
30084 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
30085 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
30086 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
30087 updated in this circumstance.
30089 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
30090 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
30091 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
30092 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
30093 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
30094 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
30097 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30098 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
30099 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
30100 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
30101 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
30102 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
30103 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
30104 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
30105 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
30106 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
30108 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
30110 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
30113 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30114 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
30115 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
30118 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
30120 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
30121 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
30122 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
30123 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
30124 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
30127 .vitem &*no_cache*&
30128 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
30129 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
30130 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
30132 .vitem &*postmaster*&
30133 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
30134 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
30135 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
30136 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
30137 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
30138 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
30139 made, until the cache record expires.
30141 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30142 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
30143 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
30146 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
30148 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
30149 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
30151 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
30153 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
30154 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
30155 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
30156 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
30160 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
30161 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
30162 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
30163 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
30164 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
30166 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
30168 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
30169 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
30170 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
30171 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
30172 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
30174 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
30175 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
30176 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30178 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
30180 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30181 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
30182 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
30183 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
30184 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
30186 .vitem &*use_sender*&
30187 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30189 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
30191 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
30192 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
30193 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
30194 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
30195 usefulness of callout caching.
30198 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
30199 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
30200 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
30201 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
30202 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
30203 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
30204 these circumstances.
30206 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
30207 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
30208 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
30209 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
30210 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
30211 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
30212 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
30214 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
30215 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
30216 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
30217 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
30222 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
30223 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
30224 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
30225 .cindex "caching" "callout"
30226 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
30227 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
30228 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
30229 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
30230 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
30231 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
30233 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
30234 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
30237 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
30238 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
30239 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
30241 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
30242 commands up to and including
30246 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
30247 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
30248 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
30249 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
30250 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
30251 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
30252 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
30254 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
30255 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
30256 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
30257 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
30258 will eventually be noticed.
30260 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
30261 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
30262 behaviour will be the same.
30266 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
30267 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
30268 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
30269 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
30270 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
30271 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
30274 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
30276 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
30277 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
30278 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
30279 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
30280 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
30281 550 Sender verification failed
30283 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
30284 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
30285 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
30286 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
30289 verify = sender/no_details
30292 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
30293 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
30294 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
30295 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
30296 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
30297 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
30298 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
30301 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
30302 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
30303 verification also fails.
30305 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
30306 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
30309 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
30310 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
30311 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
30314 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
30316 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
30317 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
30318 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
30319 verification to succeed.
30321 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
30322 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
30323 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
30324 option. For example:
30326 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
30328 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
30329 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
30331 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
30332 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
30333 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
30334 address and a report is output for each of them.
30338 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
30339 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
30340 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
30341 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
30342 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
30343 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
30344 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
30348 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
30349 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
30350 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
30351 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
30352 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
30353 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
30355 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
30356 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
30357 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
30358 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
30361 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
30363 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
30365 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
30366 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
30368 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
30369 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
30372 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
30373 use for the DNS query. The default is:
30375 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
30377 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
30378 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
30379 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
30380 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
30383 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
30385 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
30386 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
30387 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
30389 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
30390 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
30391 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
30392 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
30393 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
30394 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
30395 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
30396 of legitimate HELO domains.
30398 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
30399 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
30400 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
30401 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
30404 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
30406 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
30407 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
30408 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
30413 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
30414 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
30415 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
30416 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
30417 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
30418 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
30419 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
30420 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
30422 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
30423 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
30424 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
30425 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
30426 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
30427 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
30428 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
30430 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
30431 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
30434 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
30435 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
30438 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
30439 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
30442 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
30443 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
30445 recipients = +batv_senders
30447 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
30448 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
30450 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
30451 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
30452 !condition = $prvscheck_result
30454 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
30455 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
30456 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
30457 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
30458 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
30460 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
30461 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
30462 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
30463 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
30464 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
30465 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
30466 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
30468 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
30469 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
30470 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
30471 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
30475 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
30477 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
30478 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
30479 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
30482 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
30485 external_smtp_batv:
30487 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
30488 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
30489 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
30490 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
30493 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
30497 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
30498 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
30499 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
30500 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
30501 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
30502 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
30503 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
30504 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
30505 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
30506 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
30508 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
30509 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
30510 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
30511 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
30512 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
30513 same host is fulfilling both functions,
30515 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
30517 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
30518 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
30519 system to arbitrary domains.
30522 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
30523 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
30524 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
30525 example, suppose you want to do the following:
30528 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
30529 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
30530 &'my.dom2.example'&.
30532 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
30533 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
30535 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
30536 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
30540 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
30542 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
30543 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
30544 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
30546 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
30550 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
30551 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
30553 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
30554 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
30555 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
30556 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
30557 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
30558 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
30559 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30563 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
30564 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
30565 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
30566 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
30567 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30569 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
30570 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
30571 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
30572 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
30573 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
30574 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
30575 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
30580 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30581 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30583 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
30584 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
30585 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
30586 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
30587 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
30588 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
30591 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
30592 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
30593 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
30594 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
30595 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
30597 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
30598 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
30599 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
30602 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
30603 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
30605 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
30606 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
30607 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
30609 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
30610 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
30612 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
30615 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
30618 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
30619 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
30620 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
30622 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
30623 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
30624 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
30625 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
30626 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
30627 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
30629 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
30630 temporarily created in a file called:
30632 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
30634 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
30635 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
30636 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
30637 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
30638 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
30640 control = no_mbox_unspool
30642 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
30643 same directory by default.
30647 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
30648 .cindex "virus scanning"
30649 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
30650 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
30651 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
30652 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
30653 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
30654 in memory and thus are much faster.
30657 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
30658 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
30661 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
30662 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
30663 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
30664 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
30666 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
30668 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
30670 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
30672 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
30674 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
30675 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
30680 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
30681 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
30682 Security (currenty at version 1.1.7).
30683 You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
30684 at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
30685 This scanner type takes one option,
30686 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30687 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30688 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30689 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30690 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
30691 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
30694 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
30695 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
30697 If you omit the argument, the default path
30698 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
30700 If you use a remote host,
30701 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
30702 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
30703 For information about available commands and their options you may use
30705 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
30713 .vitem &%aveserver%&
30714 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30715 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
30716 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
30717 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
30720 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
30725 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
30726 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
30727 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
30728 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
30729 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
30731 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
30732 a UNIX socket specification,
30733 a TCP socket specification,
30734 or a (global) option.
30736 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
30737 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
30738 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
30739 and the second a port number,
30740 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
30741 These per-server options are supported:
30743 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
30746 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
30747 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
30749 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
30753 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
30754 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
30755 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
30756 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
30757 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
30759 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
30761 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
30762 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
30763 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
30764 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
30765 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
30766 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
30768 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
30769 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
30770 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
30771 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
30772 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
30773 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
30774 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
30775 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
30776 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
30778 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
30779 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
30780 (Connection refused)
30783 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
30784 contributing the code for this scanner.
30787 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
30788 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
30789 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
30790 type takes 3 mandatory options:
30793 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
30794 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
30797 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
30798 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
30799 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
30800 the &"trigger"& expression.
30803 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
30804 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
30805 &"name"& expression.
30808 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
30810 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
30812 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
30813 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
30814 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
30815 configuration setting:
30817 av_scanner = cmdline:\
30818 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
30819 found in file:'(.+)'
30822 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
30823 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
30825 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30826 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30827 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30828 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30831 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
30832 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
30834 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
30835 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
30838 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
30839 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
30840 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
30844 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
30846 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
30849 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
30850 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
30851 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
30853 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
30855 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
30856 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
30858 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
30859 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30860 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
30861 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
30862 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
30865 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
30867 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
30870 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
30871 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
30872 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
30873 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
30874 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
30875 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
30876 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
30878 av_scanner = mksd:2
30880 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
30883 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
30884 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
30885 running on the local machine.
30886 There are four options:
30887 an address (which may be an IP addres and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
30888 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
30889 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
30890 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
30891 an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
30894 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
30896 Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
30897 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
30898 Both regular-expressions are required.
30901 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
30902 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
30903 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
30904 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
30905 client communication. For example:
30907 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
30909 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
30913 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
30914 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
30917 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
30918 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
30919 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
30920 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
30921 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
30922 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
30925 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
30927 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
30929 The first element can then be one of
30932 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
30933 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
30936 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
30937 the condition fails immediately.
30939 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
30940 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
30941 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
30943 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
30944 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
30948 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
30949 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
30950 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
30953 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
30954 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
30957 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
30959 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
30962 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
30963 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
30964 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
30965 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
30968 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
30969 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
30970 &%malware%& condition.
30972 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
30973 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
30975 Here is a very simple scanning example:
30977 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30981 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
30983 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30985 malware = */defer_ok
30987 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
30988 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
30990 av_scanner = $acl_m0
30992 in the main Exim configuration.
30994 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30995 set acl_m0 = sophie
30998 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30999 set acl_m0 = aveserver
31004 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
31005 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
31006 .cindex "spam scanning"
31007 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
31009 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
31010 score and a report for the message.
31012 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
31014 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
31015 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
31016 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
31019 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31021 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31023 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31024 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31027 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31028 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31029 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31030 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31031 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31032 configuration as follows (example):
31034 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31038 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31040 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31042 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31046 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31047 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31048 file name instead of an address/port pair:
31050 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31052 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31053 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31054 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
31055 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
31057 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
31058 192.168.2.11 783 : \
31061 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
31062 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
31063 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
31067 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
31068 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
31069 and changeable in the usual way.
31071 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
31072 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
31073 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
31074 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
31076 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
31078 The supported option are:
31080 pri=<priority> Selection priority
31081 weight=<value> Selection bias
31082 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
31083 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31084 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
31085 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
31088 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
31089 higher values being tried first.
31090 The deafult priority is 1.
31092 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
31093 Within a priority set
31094 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
31095 The default value for selection bias is 1.
31097 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
31098 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
31099 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
31100 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
31102 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
31103 are the usual Exim time interval standard, eg. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
31105 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
31106 The default value is two minutes.
31108 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31109 a failed connect is made.
31110 The default is to not retry.
31113 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
31114 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
31115 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
31118 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
31119 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
31121 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31124 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
31125 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
31126 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
31127 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
31129 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
31133 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
31134 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
31135 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
31136 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
31137 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
31139 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
31140 (eg. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
31142 or the use of PRDR,
31143 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
31144 are needed to use this feature.
31146 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
31147 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
31148 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
31151 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
31152 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
31153 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
31156 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31157 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
31161 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
31162 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
31163 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
31164 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
31166 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
31167 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
31168 variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
31169 available for use at delivery time.
31172 .vitem &$spam_score$&
31173 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
31174 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
31176 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
31177 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
31178 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
31179 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
31180 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
31182 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
31183 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
31184 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
31185 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
31186 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
31188 .vitem &$spam_report$&
31189 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
31190 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
31193 .vitem &$spam_action$&
31194 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
31195 spam score versus threshold.
31196 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
31201 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
31202 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
31203 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
31205 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
31206 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
31207 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
31208 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
31209 spam condition, like this:
31211 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31212 spam = joe/defer_ok
31214 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
31216 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
31219 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
31220 warn spam = nobody:true
31221 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
31222 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
31224 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
31225 # is over threshold
31227 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
31229 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
31230 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
31232 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
31237 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
31238 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
31239 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31240 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
31241 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
31242 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
31243 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
31244 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
31245 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
31246 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
31249 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
31250 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
31251 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
31252 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
31253 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
31254 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
31255 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
31257 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
31258 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
31259 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
31260 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
31261 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
31263 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
31264 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
31265 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
31266 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
31267 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
31270 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
31272 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
31276 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
31278 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
31279 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
31280 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
31281 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
31283 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
31284 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
31285 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
31286 the full path and file name.
31288 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
31289 filename, and the default path is then used.
31291 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
31292 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
31293 a file with its original, proposed filename using
31295 decode = $mime_filename
31297 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
31298 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
31299 automatically unlinked.
31301 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
31302 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
31303 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
31304 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
31305 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
31307 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
31308 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
31309 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
31311 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
31312 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
31313 available in the MIME ACL:
31316 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
31317 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
31318 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
31319 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
31320 contains the empty string.
31322 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
31323 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
31324 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
31330 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
31331 case-insensitively.
31333 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
31334 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
31335 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
31336 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
31337 only used for display purposes.
31339 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
31340 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
31341 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
31343 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
31344 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
31345 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
31347 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
31348 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31349 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
31350 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
31351 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
31353 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
31354 This variable contains the normalized content of the
31355 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
31356 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
31358 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
31359 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
31360 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
31361 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
31365 application/octet-stream
31369 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
31372 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
31373 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31374 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
31375 containing the decoded data.
31380 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
31381 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
31382 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
31383 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
31384 RFC2047 or RFC2231 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
31386 found, this variable contains the empty string.
31388 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
31389 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
31390 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
31391 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
31393 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
31394 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
31398 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
31401 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
31402 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
31405 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
31406 and the rest are attachments.
31409 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
31412 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
31413 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
31414 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
31416 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
31417 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
31418 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
31419 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
31421 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
31422 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
31423 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
31424 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
31425 want to carry out specific actions on them.
31427 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
31428 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
31429 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
31430 decoding is fully recursive.
31432 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
31433 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
31434 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
31435 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
31436 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
31437 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
31438 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
31443 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
31444 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
31445 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
31446 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
31447 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
31449 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
31450 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
31451 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
31452 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
31453 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
31455 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
31456 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
31457 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
31458 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
31459 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
31460 32K characters are checked.
31462 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
31463 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
31464 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
31465 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
31466 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
31468 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
31469 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
31471 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
31472 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
31473 matching regular expression.
31475 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
31481 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
31482 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
31483 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31484 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
31485 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
31486 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
31487 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
31488 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
31489 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
31490 use the &%demime%& condition.
31492 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
31493 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
31494 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
31495 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
31496 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
31497 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
31499 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
31500 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
31503 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
31504 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
31506 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
31507 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
31508 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
31509 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
31511 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
31512 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
31513 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
31515 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
31518 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
31519 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
31520 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
31521 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
31522 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
31523 zero, no error occurred.
31525 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
31526 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
31527 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
31528 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
31532 .vitem &$found_extension$&
31533 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
31534 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
31535 extension it found.
31538 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
31539 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
31541 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
31542 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
31543 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
31546 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
31547 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
31549 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
31551 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
31552 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
31553 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
31554 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
31556 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
31557 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
31558 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
31567 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31568 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31570 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
31571 "Local scan function"
31572 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
31573 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
31574 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
31575 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
31576 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
31578 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
31579 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
31580 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
31581 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
31582 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
31584 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
31585 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
31586 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
31587 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
31589 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
31590 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
31591 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
31592 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
31594 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
31595 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
31596 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
31597 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
31598 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
31599 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
31600 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
31601 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
31602 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
31606 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
31607 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
31608 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
31609 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
31610 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
31611 directory, so you might set
31613 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
31615 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
31616 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
31617 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
31618 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
31619 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
31620 _src/local_scan.c_.
31622 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
31623 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
31625 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31627 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
31632 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
31633 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
31634 You must include this line near the start of your code:
31636 #include "local_scan.h"
31638 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
31639 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
31640 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
31641 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
31642 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
31643 strings and pointers to character strings:
31645 #define CS (char *)
31646 #define CCS (const char *)
31647 #define CSS (char **)
31648 #define US (unsigned char *)
31649 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
31650 #define USS (unsigned char **)
31652 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
31654 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
31656 The arguments are as follows:
31659 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
31660 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
31661 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
31663 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
31664 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
31665 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
31666 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
31667 case this changes in some future version.
31669 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
31670 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
31673 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
31676 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
31677 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
31678 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
31679 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
31680 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
31681 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
31683 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
31684 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31685 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
31687 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
31688 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31689 queued without immediate delivery.
31691 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
31692 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
31693 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
31694 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
31695 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
31698 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
31699 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
31700 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
31703 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31704 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
31705 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
31706 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
31707 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
31708 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
31709 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31711 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31712 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
31713 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31716 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
31717 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
31718 &%-oe%& command line options.
31722 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
31723 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
31724 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
31725 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
31726 want to do this, you must have the line
31728 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31730 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
31731 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
31732 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
31735 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
31736 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
31737 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
31738 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
31739 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
31740 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
31742 static int my_integer_option = 42;
31743 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
31745 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
31746 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
31747 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
31750 int local_scan_options_count =
31751 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
31753 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
31754 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
31758 my_string = some string of text...
31760 The available types of option data are as follows:
31763 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
31764 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
31765 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
31766 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
31767 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
31768 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
31771 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
31772 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
31773 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
31774 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
31777 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
31778 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
31781 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
31782 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
31783 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
31784 printed with the suffix K or M.
31786 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
31787 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
31788 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
31789 always output in octal.
31791 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
31792 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
31793 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
31795 .vitem &*opt_time*&
31796 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
31797 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
31800 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
31801 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
31805 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
31806 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
31807 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
31808 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
31809 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
31810 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
31811 C variables are as follows:
31814 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
31815 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
31817 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
31818 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
31820 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
31821 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
31822 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
31823 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
31826 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
31827 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
31828 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
31831 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
31832 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
31836 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
31837 selected, you should use code like this:
31839 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
31840 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
31842 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
31843 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
31844 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
31846 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
31847 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
31850 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
31851 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
31853 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
31854 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
31856 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
31857 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
31858 &%-bh%& command line option.
31860 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
31861 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
31862 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
31864 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
31865 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
31866 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
31867 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
31869 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
31870 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
31871 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
31873 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
31874 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
31876 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
31877 The number of accepted recipients.
31879 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
31880 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
31881 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
31882 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
31883 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
31884 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
31885 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
31886 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
31887 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
31888 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
31889 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
31890 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
31892 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
31893 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
31895 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
31896 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
31897 locally-submitted messages.
31899 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
31900 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
31901 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
31903 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
31904 The name of the sending host, if known.
31906 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
31907 The port on the sending host.
31909 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
31910 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
31912 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
31913 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
31915 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
31916 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
31917 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
31921 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
31922 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
31923 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
31924 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
31929 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
31930 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
31932 .vitem &*int&~type*&
31933 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
31934 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
31935 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
31936 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
31937 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
31938 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
31940 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
31941 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
31944 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
31945 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
31946 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
31951 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
31952 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
31955 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
31956 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
31958 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
31959 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
31960 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
31961 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
31963 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
31964 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
31965 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
31966 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
31967 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
31968 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
31969 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
31970 is NULL for all recipients.
31975 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
31976 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
31977 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
31978 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
31982 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
31983 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
31985 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
31986 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
31987 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
31988 for the process in &%newumask%&.
31990 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
31991 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
31992 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
31993 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
31994 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
31996 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
31998 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
31999 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
32000 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
32001 return value is as follows:
32006 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
32012 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
32018 The process timed out.
32022 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32025 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32026 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32027 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32028 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32029 forks a subprocess that is running
32031 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32033 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32034 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32035 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32036 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32038 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32039 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32040 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32041 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32044 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32045 *sender_authentication)*&
32046 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32049 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32051 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32054 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32055 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32056 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32057 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32058 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32060 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32061 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32064 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32065 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32066 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32067 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32068 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32069 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32070 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32071 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32073 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32074 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32075 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32076 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32077 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32078 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32080 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32081 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32082 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32083 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32085 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32086 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32087 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32088 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32089 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32090 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32091 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32092 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32093 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32094 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32096 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32097 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32099 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32100 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32103 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32104 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32105 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32106 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32107 match the specification, the function does nothing.
32110 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32111 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32112 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32113 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32114 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32115 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32117 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32119 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32120 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32121 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32122 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32123 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32126 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32127 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
32128 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
32129 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
32130 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
32131 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
32132 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
32133 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
32135 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
32136 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
32137 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
32139 &`OK `& match succeeded
32140 &`FAIL `& match failed
32141 &`DEFER `& match deferred
32143 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
32144 inability to contact a database.
32146 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32148 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
32149 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
32150 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32152 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32154 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
32155 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
32156 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32158 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
32160 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
32163 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
32165 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
32166 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
32167 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
32168 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
32169 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
32170 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
32173 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
32175 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
32176 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
32177 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
32178 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
32179 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
32180 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
32183 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
32184 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
32185 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
32186 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
32188 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
32189 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
32190 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
32191 value afterwards. For example:
32193 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
32194 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
32195 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
32198 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
32199 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
32200 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
32201 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
32208 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
32209 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
32210 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
32211 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
32212 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
32213 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
32214 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
32215 binary string is returned with an error message.
32217 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
32218 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
32219 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
32221 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
32222 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
32223 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
32224 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
32225 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
32227 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
32228 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
32229 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
32231 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
32232 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
32233 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
32234 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
32238 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
32239 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
32242 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32243 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
32244 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
32245 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
32246 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
32247 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
32248 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
32249 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
32252 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
32253 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
32255 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
32256 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
32257 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
32258 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
32259 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
32260 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
32261 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
32263 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
32264 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
32266 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
32267 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
32268 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
32269 multiple output lines.
32271 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
32272 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
32273 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
32274 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
32275 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
32276 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
32277 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
32280 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
32281 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
32282 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
32283 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32285 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
32286 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
32287 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32289 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
32292 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
32295 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
32296 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
32297 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
32298 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
32299 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
32300 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
32306 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
32307 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
32308 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
32309 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
32310 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
32311 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
32312 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
32315 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
32316 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
32317 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
32318 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
32320 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
32321 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
32323 store_pool = POOL_PERM
32325 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
32326 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
32327 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
32328 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
32330 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
32331 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
32332 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
32333 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
32340 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32341 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32343 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
32344 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
32345 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
32346 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
32347 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
32348 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
32349 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
32350 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
32352 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
32353 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
32354 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
32355 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
32356 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
32358 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
32359 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
32360 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
32361 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
32362 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
32363 prevent it happening on retries.
32365 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32366 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32367 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
32368 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
32369 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
32370 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
32371 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
32372 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
32375 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
32376 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
32377 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
32378 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
32379 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
32380 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
32381 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
32383 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
32384 system_filter_user = exim
32386 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
32387 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
32388 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
32389 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
32390 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
32391 by the &%reply%& command.
32394 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
32395 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
32396 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
32397 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
32399 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
32400 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
32404 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
32405 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
32406 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
32407 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
32408 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
32409 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
32412 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
32413 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
32414 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
32415 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
32416 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
32417 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
32418 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
32420 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
32421 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
32422 succeed, it will not be tried again.
32423 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
32424 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
32426 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
32427 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
32428 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
32429 to which users' filter files can refer.
32433 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
32434 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
32435 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
32436 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
32437 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
32441 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
32442 .cindex "freezing messages"
32443 .cindex "message" "freezing"
32444 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
32445 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
32446 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
32447 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
32448 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
32449 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
32450 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
32451 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
32452 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
32454 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
32456 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
32458 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
32459 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
32460 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
32461 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
32462 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
32465 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
32466 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
32467 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
32468 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
32470 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
32471 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
32472 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
32473 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
32474 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
32475 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
32476 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
32477 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
32478 message. For example:
32480 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
32481 because it contains attachments that we are \
32482 not prepared to receive."
32485 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
32486 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
32487 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
32488 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
32489 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
32490 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
32493 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
32494 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
32496 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
32497 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
32498 generated by the filter.
32500 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
32502 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
32503 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
32509 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
32510 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
32515 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
32516 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
32517 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
32518 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
32519 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
32521 headers add <string>
32522 headers remove <string>
32524 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
32525 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
32526 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
32527 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
32528 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
32530 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
32531 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
32532 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
32535 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
32536 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
32539 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
32540 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
32541 space after input continuations is ignored.
32543 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
32544 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
32545 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
32546 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
32547 header with the same name, they are all removed.
32549 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
32550 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
32551 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
32552 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
32553 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
32554 used for all recipients of the message.
32556 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
32557 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
32558 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
32559 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
32560 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
32561 until the message is actually being written (see section
32562 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
32564 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
32565 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
32566 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
32567 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
32568 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
32569 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
32570 modified more than once.
32572 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
32573 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
32576 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
32577 headers remove "Subject"
32578 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
32579 headers remove "Old-Subject"
32584 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
32585 .cindex "envelope sender"
32586 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
32588 errors_to <some address>
32590 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
32591 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
32592 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
32595 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
32597 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
32598 address if its delivery failed.
32602 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
32603 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32604 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32605 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
32606 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
32607 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
32608 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
32609 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
32610 which implements such a filter:
32615 domains = +local_domains
32616 file = /central/filters/$local_part
32621 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
32622 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
32623 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
32624 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
32626 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
32627 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
32628 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
32629 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
32631 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
32632 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
32633 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
32640 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32641 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32643 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
32644 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
32645 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
32646 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
32647 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
32648 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
32649 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
32650 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
32652 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
32653 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
32654 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
32655 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
32656 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
32658 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
32659 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
32660 loopback interface specially in any way.
32662 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
32663 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
32668 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
32669 .cindex "message" "submission"
32670 .cindex "submission mode"
32671 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
32672 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
32673 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
32674 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
32676 control = submission
32678 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
32679 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
32680 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
32681 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
32682 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
32683 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
32685 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
32686 control = submission
32688 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
32689 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
32690 is used to separate options. For example:
32692 control = submission/sender_retain
32694 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
32695 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
32696 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
32697 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
32698 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
32699 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
32700 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
32702 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
32703 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
32706 control = submission/domain=some.domain
32708 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
32709 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
32710 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
32711 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
32713 accept authenticated = *
32714 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
32715 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
32716 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
32718 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
32719 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
32720 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
32722 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
32724 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
32727 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
32729 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
32730 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
32731 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
32732 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
32734 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
32735 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
32736 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
32737 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
32738 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
32739 spoof another's address.
32741 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
32742 .cindex "line endings"
32743 .cindex "carriage return"
32745 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
32746 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
32747 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
32748 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
32749 use CRLF or just CR.
32751 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
32752 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
32753 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
32754 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
32755 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
32756 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
32757 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
32758 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
32762 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
32764 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
32767 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
32768 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
32771 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
32772 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
32773 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
32774 people trying to play silly games.
32776 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
32777 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
32785 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
32786 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
32787 .cindex "address" "qualification"
32788 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
32789 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
32790 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
32791 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
32792 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
32794 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
32795 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
32796 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
32797 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
32798 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
32800 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
32801 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
32802 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
32803 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
32804 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
32805 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
32806 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
32807 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
32812 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
32813 .cindex "&""From""& line"
32814 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
32815 .cindex "sender" "address"
32816 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
32817 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
32818 .cindex "envelope sender"
32819 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32820 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
32821 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
32822 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
32824 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
32825 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
32827 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
32828 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
32829 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
32830 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
32831 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
32832 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
32833 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
32834 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
32835 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
32837 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
32838 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
32839 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
32840 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
32841 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
32842 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
32843 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
32845 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
32846 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
32847 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
32849 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
32850 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
32851 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
32852 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
32856 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
32857 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
32858 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
32859 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
32860 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
32861 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
32862 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
32865 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
32866 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
32869 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
32870 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
32874 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
32875 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
32877 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
32878 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
32879 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
32881 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
32884 For a locally-submitted message,
32885 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
32886 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
32887 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
32888 included in log lines in this case.
32890 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
32891 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
32897 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
32898 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
32899 includes the header line:
32901 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
32904 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
32905 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
32906 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
32907 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
32908 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
32909 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
32912 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
32913 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
32914 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
32915 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
32916 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
32918 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
32919 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
32920 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
32921 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
32922 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
32923 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
32924 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
32925 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
32929 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
32930 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
32931 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
32932 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
32933 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
32934 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
32935 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
32936 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
32940 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
32941 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
32942 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32943 .cindex "message" "submission"
32944 .cindex "submission mode"
32945 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
32946 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
32949 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
32950 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
32952 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
32953 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
32955 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32956 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
32957 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
32959 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
32960 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
32962 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
32963 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
32967 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
32969 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
32970 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
32971 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
32972 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
32973 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
32974 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
32975 &%qualify_domain%&.
32977 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
32978 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
32979 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
32980 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
32983 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
32984 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
32985 .cindex "message" "submission"
32986 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
32987 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
32988 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
32989 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
32990 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
32991 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
32992 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
32993 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
32994 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
32995 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
32998 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
32999 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
33000 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
33001 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
33002 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
33004 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
33005 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
33006 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
33007 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
33009 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
33010 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
33011 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
33014 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
33015 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
33016 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
33017 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
33018 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
33019 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
33020 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
33021 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33022 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33023 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
33024 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33028 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33029 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33030 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33031 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33032 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33033 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33034 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33035 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33039 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33040 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33041 .cindex "message" "submission"
33042 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33043 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33044 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33045 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33048 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33049 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33050 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33051 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33052 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33053 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33054 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33055 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33056 line is added to the message.
33058 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33059 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33060 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33061 options true at the same time.
33063 .cindex "submission mode"
33064 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33065 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33066 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33067 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33069 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33070 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33071 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33072 created as follows:
33075 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33076 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33077 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33079 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33080 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33082 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33083 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33086 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33087 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33088 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33089 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33091 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33092 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33093 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33094 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33098 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33099 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33100 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33101 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33102 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33103 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33104 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33105 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33106 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33108 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33109 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33110 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33111 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33112 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33113 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33115 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33116 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33117 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33119 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
33120 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
33121 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
33123 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
33124 X-added-second: another added header line
33126 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
33128 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
33129 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
33130 Each header-line is separately expanded.
33132 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
33133 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
33134 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
33135 not part of the names. For example:
33137 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
33140 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
33141 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
33142 Each item is separately expanded.
33143 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
33144 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
33145 will act as list separators.
33147 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
33148 items are expanded at routing time,
33149 and then associated with all addresses that are
33150 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
33151 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
33152 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
33154 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
33155 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
33156 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
33157 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
33159 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
33160 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
33161 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
33164 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
33165 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
33166 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
33167 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
33168 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
33169 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
33170 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
33172 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
33173 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
33174 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
33175 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
33177 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
33178 the following consequences:
33181 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
33182 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
33183 to it, at all times.
33185 Header lines that are added by a router's
33186 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
33187 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
33189 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
33190 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
33192 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
33193 a later router or by a transport.
33195 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
33196 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
33198 headers_remove = subject
33199 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
33203 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
33204 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
33210 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
33211 .cindex "address" "constructed"
33212 .cindex "constructed address"
33213 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
33216 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
33220 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
33222 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
33223 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
33224 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
33225 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
33226 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
33227 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
33228 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
33229 there is no password file entry.
33232 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
33233 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
33234 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
33235 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
33236 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
33237 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
33238 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
33239 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
33243 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
33244 .cindex "case of local parts"
33245 .cindex "local part" "case of"
33246 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
33247 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
33248 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
33249 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
33250 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
33251 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
33254 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
33255 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
33256 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
33257 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
33258 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
33262 domains = +local_domains
33263 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
33264 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
33267 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
33268 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
33269 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
33270 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
33271 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
33275 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
33276 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
33277 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
33278 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
33279 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
33280 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
33281 empty components for compatibility.
33285 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
33286 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
33287 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
33288 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
33289 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
33290 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
33292 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
33293 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
33294 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
33295 example, a header such as
33299 might get rewritten as
33301 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
33303 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
33304 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
33307 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
33308 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
33309 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
33310 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
33311 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
33312 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
33313 .ecindex IIDmesproc
33317 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33318 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33320 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
33321 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
33322 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
33323 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
33324 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
33325 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
33326 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
33329 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
33331 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
33333 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
33336 For mail delivery, the following are available:
33339 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
33341 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
33344 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
33347 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
33348 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
33351 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
33352 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
33353 used to contain the envelope information.
33357 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
33358 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
33359 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
33360 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
33361 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
33364 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33365 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
33366 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
33367 processing is the same in both cases.
33369 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
33370 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
33371 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
33372 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
33373 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
33374 .cindex "transport" "filter"
33375 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
33376 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
33379 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
33380 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
33381 required for the transaction.
33383 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
33384 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
33385 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
33386 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
33387 is called for verification.
33389 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
33390 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
33391 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
33393 .cindex "carriage return"
33395 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33396 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
33397 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33400 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
33401 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
33402 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
33403 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
33404 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
33405 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
33406 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
33407 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
33408 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
33410 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
33411 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
33412 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
33413 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
33415 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
33416 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
33417 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
33418 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
33420 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33421 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
33422 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
33423 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
33424 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
33425 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
33426 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
33427 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
33428 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
33429 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
33431 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
33432 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
33434 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33435 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
33436 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
33437 square bracket of the IP address.
33442 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
33443 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
33444 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
33445 .cindex "host" "error"
33446 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
33447 message errors, and recipient errors.
33450 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
33451 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
33452 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
33455 Connection refused or timed out,
33457 Any error response code on connection,
33459 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
33461 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
33463 I/O errors at any time,
33465 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
33466 the &"."& at the end of the data.
33469 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
33470 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
33471 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
33472 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
33473 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
33474 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
33475 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
33476 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
33478 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
33479 .cindex "message" "error"
33480 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
33481 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
33482 message errors are:
33485 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
33488 Timeout after MAIL,
33490 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
33491 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
33492 connection at any other time.
33495 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
33496 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
33497 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
33498 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
33499 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
33500 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
33501 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
33502 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
33503 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
33504 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
33506 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
33507 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
33508 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
33511 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
33512 .cindex "recipient" "error"
33513 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
33514 recipient errors are:
33517 Any error response to RCPT,
33519 Timeout after RCPT.
33522 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
33523 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
33524 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
33525 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
33526 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
33527 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
33528 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
33529 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
33530 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
33531 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
33532 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
33533 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
33534 the retry clock is reset.
33536 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
33537 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
33538 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
33539 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
33540 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
33541 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
33542 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
33543 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
33544 recipient's retry time.
33547 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
33548 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
33549 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
33550 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
33551 until the next delivery attempt.
33553 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
33554 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
33555 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
33556 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
33557 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
33560 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
33561 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
33562 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
33563 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
33564 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
33565 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
33566 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
33568 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
33569 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
33570 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
33571 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
33572 then to be treated as a host error.
33574 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
33575 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
33576 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
33577 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
33578 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
33583 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
33584 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
33585 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
33588 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
33589 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
33590 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
33592 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
33594 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
33595 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
33596 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
33597 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
33598 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
33599 stream and exits with an error code.
33601 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
33602 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
33603 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
33604 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
33606 .cindex "carriage return"
33608 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33609 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
33610 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33612 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
33613 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
33614 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
33616 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
33617 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
33618 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
33619 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
33620 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
33621 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
33622 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
33623 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
33625 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33626 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
33627 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
33628 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
33629 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
33630 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
33631 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
33632 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
33633 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
33635 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
33636 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
33637 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
33639 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
33640 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
33641 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
33642 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
33643 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
33645 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
33646 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
33647 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
33648 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
33649 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
33650 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
33651 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
33653 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
33654 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
33655 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
33656 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
33657 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
33659 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
33660 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
33661 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
33662 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
33663 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
33664 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
33665 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
33666 a delivery process.
33668 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
33669 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
33670 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
33671 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
33672 however, available with &'inetd'&.
33674 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
33675 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
33676 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
33677 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
33679 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
33680 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
33681 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
33685 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
33686 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
33687 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
33688 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
33689 the error response to the last command. The default value for
33690 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
33691 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
33692 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
33695 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
33696 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
33697 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
33698 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
33699 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
33700 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
33701 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
33702 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
33703 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
33704 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
33705 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
33709 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
33710 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
33711 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
33712 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
33713 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
33714 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
33715 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
33716 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
33718 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
33719 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
33720 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
33721 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
33722 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
33725 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
33726 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
33727 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
33729 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
33730 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
33731 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
33732 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
33733 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
33738 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
33739 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
33740 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
33741 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
33742 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33744 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
33745 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
33746 called with the &%-bv%& option.
33748 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
33749 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
33750 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
33751 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
33752 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
33753 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
33754 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
33759 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
33760 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
33761 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
33762 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
33763 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
33764 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
33765 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33767 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
33768 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
33769 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
33770 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
33771 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
33772 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
33773 argument. For example,
33781 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
33782 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
33783 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
33784 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
33785 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
33787 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
33788 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
33789 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
33790 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
33791 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
33792 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
33793 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
33794 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
33796 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
33797 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
33798 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
33799 whatever the form of its argument. For
33802 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
33803 $sender_host_address
33805 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33806 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
33807 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
33808 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
33809 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
33810 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
33811 for it to change them before running the command.
33815 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
33816 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
33817 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
33818 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
33819 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
33820 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
33821 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
33822 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
33823 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
33824 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
33825 runs for RCPT commands:
33829 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
33833 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
33834 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
33835 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
33836 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
33837 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
33838 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
33839 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
33840 envelope along with the message.
33842 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
33843 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
33844 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
33845 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
33846 can be used to specify it.
33848 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
33849 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
33850 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
33851 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
33852 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
33855 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
33856 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
33857 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
33862 driver = manualroute
33863 transport = smtp_appendfile
33864 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
33868 driver = appendfile
33869 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
33874 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
33875 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
33876 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
33880 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
33881 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
33882 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
33883 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
33884 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
33885 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
33886 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
33887 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
33888 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
33889 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
33891 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
33892 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
33894 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
33895 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
33896 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
33897 make some use of automatically, for example:
33899 554 Unexpected end of file
33900 Transaction started in line 10
33901 Error detected in line 14
33903 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
33906 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
33907 The error message was:
33909 501 '>' missing at end of address
33911 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
33912 The error was detected in line 12.
33913 The SMTP command at fault was:
33915 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
33917 1 previous message was successfully processed.
33918 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
33920 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
33921 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
33923 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
33924 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
33928 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33929 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33931 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
33932 "Customizing messages"
33933 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
33934 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
33935 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
33936 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
33937 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
33939 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
33940 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
33941 option. Exim also adds the line
33943 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
33945 to all warning and bounce messages,
33948 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
33949 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
33950 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
33951 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
33952 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
33953 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
33954 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
33956 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
33957 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
33958 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
33959 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
33960 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
33963 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
33964 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
33965 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
33966 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
33967 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
33968 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
33969 option, rounded to a whole number.
33971 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
33974 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
33975 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
33977 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
33978 failing addresses with their error messages.
33980 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
33981 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
33984 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
33985 The fields exist for back-compatibility
33989 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
33990 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
33991 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
33993 Subject: Mail delivery failed
33994 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
33995 {: returning message to sender}}
33997 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
33999 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34000 {that you sent }{sent by
34004 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
34005 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
34007 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
34009 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
34012 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
34014 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
34017 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
34018 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
34019 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
34020 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
34021 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
34025 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34026 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34028 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34029 the delayed addresses.
34031 The third item then ends the message.
34034 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34035 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34037 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34038 $warn_message_delay
34040 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34042 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34043 {that you sent }{sent by
34047 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34048 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34050 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34051 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34052 The date of the message is: $h_date
34054 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34056 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34057 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34058 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34059 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34060 the message will be returned to you.
34062 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34063 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34064 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34065 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34066 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34067 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34068 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34069 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34075 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34076 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34078 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34079 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34080 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34084 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34085 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
34086 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34087 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34088 routing explicitly:
34090 send_to_smart_host:
34091 driver = manualroute
34092 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34093 transport = remote_smtp
34095 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34096 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34097 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34098 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34099 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34104 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34105 .cindex "mailing lists"
34106 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34107 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34108 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34110 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34111 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34112 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34113 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34117 domains = lists.example
34118 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34121 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34124 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
34125 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
34126 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
34127 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
34129 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
34130 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
34133 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
34134 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
34135 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
34136 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
34137 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
34139 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
34140 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
34141 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
34142 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
34143 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
34144 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
34145 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
34146 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
34147 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
34151 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
34152 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
34153 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
34154 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
34155 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
34156 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
34157 addresses are not rigorously checked.
34159 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
34160 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
34161 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
34162 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
34163 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
34167 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
34168 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
34169 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
34170 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
34171 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
34172 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
34173 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
34174 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
34175 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
34176 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
34178 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
34179 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
34180 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
34181 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
34182 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
34183 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
34184 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
34185 pre-existing messages.
34187 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
34188 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
34189 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
34190 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
34191 one level of expansion anyway.
34195 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
34196 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
34197 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
34198 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
34199 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
34200 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
34202 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
34203 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
34207 domains = lists.example
34208 local_part_suffix = -request
34209 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
34214 domains = lists.example
34215 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
34216 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
34217 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34220 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34225 domains = lists.example
34227 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
34229 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
34230 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
34231 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
34234 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
34235 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
34236 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
34237 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
34238 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
34239 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
34240 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
34241 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
34242 &"unrouteable address"& error.
34244 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
34245 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
34246 the address, giving a suitable error message.
34251 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
34253 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
34254 .cindex "envelope sender"
34255 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
34256 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
34257 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
34258 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
34259 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
34260 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
34262 .oindex &%errors_to%&
34263 .oindex &%return_path%&
34264 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
34265 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
34266 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
34267 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
34268 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
34269 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
34270 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
34276 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34277 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34279 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
34280 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
34281 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
34282 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
34283 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
34284 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
34285 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
34288 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
34290 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34291 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
34292 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
34293 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
34294 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
34295 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
34297 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
34298 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
34299 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
34300 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
34304 domains = ! +local_domains
34306 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34307 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
34310 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
34311 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
34312 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
34313 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
34316 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
34317 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
34318 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
34319 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
34320 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
34324 domains = ! +local_domains
34325 transport = remote_smtp
34327 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
34328 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34331 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
34332 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
34333 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
34334 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
34337 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
34338 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
34339 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
34340 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
34341 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
34342 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
34350 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
34351 .cindex "virtual domains"
34352 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
34353 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
34357 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
34358 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
34359 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
34361 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
34362 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
34363 have login accounts on that host.
34366 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
34367 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
34368 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
34369 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
34370 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
34371 to a router of this form:
34375 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
34376 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
34379 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
34380 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
34381 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
34382 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
34383 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
34384 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
34386 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
34387 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
34388 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
34389 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
34391 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
34392 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
34393 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
34397 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
34398 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
34399 transport = my_mailboxes
34401 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
34402 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
34403 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
34404 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
34405 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
34409 driver = appendfile
34410 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
34413 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
34414 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
34416 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
34417 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
34418 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
34419 information about the domains.
34423 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
34424 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
34425 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
34426 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
34427 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
34428 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
34429 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
34430 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
34431 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
34432 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
34433 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
34434 example, consider this router:
34439 file = $home/.forward
34440 local_part_suffix = -*
34441 local_part_suffix_optional
34444 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
34445 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
34446 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
34447 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
34449 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
34450 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
34453 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
34454 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
34455 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
34456 control over which suffixes are valid.
34458 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
34459 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
34465 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
34466 local_part_suffix = -*
34467 local_part_suffix_optional
34470 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
34471 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
34472 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
34473 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
34474 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
34478 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
34479 .cindex "vacation processing"
34480 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
34481 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
34482 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
34483 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
34484 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
34487 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
34488 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
34489 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
34490 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
34492 spqr, vacation-spqr
34495 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
34496 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
34497 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
34498 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
34499 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
34503 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
34504 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
34508 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
34509 .cindex "message" "copying every"
34510 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
34511 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
34512 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
34513 each day's messages.
34515 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
34516 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
34517 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
34518 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
34522 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
34523 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
34524 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
34525 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
34526 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
34527 permanently connected.
34529 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
34530 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
34531 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
34534 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
34535 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
34536 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
34537 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
34538 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
34539 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
34540 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
34541 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
34543 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
34544 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
34545 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
34546 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
34547 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
34548 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
34551 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
34552 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
34553 intermittent host. For example:
34555 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
34557 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
34558 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
34559 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
34560 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
34561 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
34562 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
34565 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
34566 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
34567 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
34568 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
34569 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
34570 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
34571 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
34575 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
34576 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
34577 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
34578 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
34579 delivered immediately.
34581 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34582 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
34583 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
34584 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
34585 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
34586 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
34587 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
34588 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
34589 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
34590 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
34591 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
34592 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
34593 single SMTP connection.
34597 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34598 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34600 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
34601 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
34602 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
34603 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
34604 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
34605 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
34606 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
34607 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
34608 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
34609 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
34612 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
34613 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
34614 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
34615 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
34616 email is not desirable.
34618 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
34619 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
34620 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
34621 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
34622 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
34623 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
34624 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
34626 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
34627 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
34628 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
34629 before sending a message to the smart host.
34631 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
34632 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
34633 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
34635 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
34636 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
34637 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
34638 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
34639 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
34640 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
34641 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
34643 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
34647 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
34648 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
34650 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
34651 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
34652 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
34653 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
34654 successful, a zero return code is given.
34656 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
34657 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
34658 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
34659 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
34660 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
34663 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
34664 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
34665 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
34667 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
34668 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
34669 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
34670 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
34671 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
34673 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
34674 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
34675 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
34677 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
34678 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
34679 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
34680 are ever generated.
34682 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
34684 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
34685 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
34686 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
34689 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
34690 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
34691 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
34692 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
34693 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
34694 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
34699 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34700 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34702 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
34703 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
34704 .cindex "log" "types of"
34705 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
34710 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
34711 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
34712 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
34713 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
34714 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
34715 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
34716 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
34717 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
34719 .cindex "reject log"
34720 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
34721 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
34722 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
34723 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
34724 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
34725 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
34726 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
34727 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
34728 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
34731 .cindex "panic log"
34732 .cindex "system log"
34733 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
34734 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
34735 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
34736 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
34737 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
34738 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
34739 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
34740 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
34741 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
34744 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
34745 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
34746 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
34748 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
34751 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
34752 ways of changing this:
34755 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
34760 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
34762 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
34765 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
34769 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
34770 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34771 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
34772 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
34773 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
34774 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
34779 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
34780 .cindex "log" "destination"
34781 .cindex "log" "to file"
34782 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
34784 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
34785 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
34786 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
34787 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
34788 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
34789 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
34790 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
34792 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
34793 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
34794 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
34795 references to the host name:
34797 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
34799 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
34800 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
34801 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
34802 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
34803 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
34806 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
34807 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
34808 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
34809 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
34810 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
34811 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
34812 implying the use of a default path.
34814 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
34815 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
34816 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
34817 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
34818 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
34819 equivalent to the setting:
34821 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
34823 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
34824 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
34825 that is where the logs are written.
34827 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
34828 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
34830 Here are some examples of possible settings:
34832 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
34833 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
34834 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
34835 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
34837 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
34842 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
34843 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34844 .cindex "cycling logs"
34845 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34846 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
34847 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
34848 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
34849 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
34850 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
34851 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
34853 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
34854 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
34855 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
34856 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
34857 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
34858 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
34859 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
34860 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
34861 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
34862 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
34863 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
34868 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
34869 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
34870 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
34871 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
34872 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
34873 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
34874 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
34875 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
34877 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
34878 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
34879 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
34880 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
34882 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
34883 examples of names generated by the above examples:
34885 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
34886 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
34887 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
34888 /var/log/exim/main.200212
34890 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
34891 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
34892 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
34893 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
34895 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
34896 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
34897 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
34898 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
34899 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
34900 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
34903 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
34904 /var/log/exim-panic.log
34905 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
34906 /var/log/exim/panic
34910 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
34911 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
34912 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
34913 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
34914 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
34915 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
34916 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
34917 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
34918 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
34919 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
34920 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
34921 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
34922 the time and host name to each line.
34923 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
34926 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
34928 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
34930 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
34933 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
34934 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
34935 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
34936 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
34938 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
34939 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
34940 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
34941 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
34942 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
34943 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
34944 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
34945 RFC 3164, you should set
34947 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
34949 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
34950 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
34952 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
34953 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
34954 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
34955 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
34956 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
34957 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
34958 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
34959 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
34960 name, and pid as added by syslog:
34962 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
34963 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
34964 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
34965 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
34968 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
34971 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
34972 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
34973 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
34974 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
34976 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
34977 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
34978 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
34979 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
34980 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
34981 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
34983 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
34984 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
34985 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
34988 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
34990 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
34991 without modification.
34993 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
34994 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
34995 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
35000 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
35001 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
35002 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
35003 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
35004 timestamp. The flags are:
35006 &`<=`& message arrival
35007 &`=>`& normal message delivery
35008 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
35009 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
35010 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
35011 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
35012 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
35016 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
35017 .cindex "log" "reception line"
35018 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35019 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
35020 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
35022 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
35023 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35024 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35026 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35027 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35028 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35032 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35036 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35037 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35038 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35039 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35040 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35041 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35042 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35043 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35044 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35045 name in parentheses.
35047 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35048 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35049 the log containing text like these examples:
35051 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35052 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35054 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35057 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35058 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35061 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
35062 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35063 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35064 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35065 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35066 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35067 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35068 suite that was used.
35070 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35071 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35072 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35073 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35074 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35075 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35076 authenticator name.
35078 .cindex "size" "of message"
35079 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35080 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35081 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35082 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35085 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35086 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35090 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35091 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
35092 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35093 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35094 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
35095 to fit it on the page:
35097 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35098 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
35099 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35100 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35101 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35103 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35104 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35105 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35106 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35107 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35109 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35110 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35111 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35112 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35114 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
35115 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
35117 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
35119 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
35120 parentheses afterwards.
35122 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35123 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
35124 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
35125 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
35126 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
35127 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35129 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
35130 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
35131 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
35132 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
35133 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
35135 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
35136 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
35138 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35139 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35142 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
35143 .cindex "discarded messages"
35144 .cindex "message" "discarded"
35145 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
35146 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
35147 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
35149 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
35150 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
35152 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
35153 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
35155 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
35156 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
35160 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
35161 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
35163 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
35164 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
35166 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
35167 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
35168 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
35170 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
35171 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
35173 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
35174 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
35175 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
35179 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
35180 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
35181 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
35182 following form is logged:
35184 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
35185 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
35187 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
35188 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
35190 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
35191 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
35192 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
35193 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
35194 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
35196 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
35197 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
35198 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
35199 flagged with &`**`&.
35203 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
35204 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
35205 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
35206 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
35207 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
35211 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
35214 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
35216 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
35217 at the end of its processing.
35222 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
35223 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
35224 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
35225 the following table:
35227 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
35228 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
35229 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35230 &`CV `& certificate verification status
35231 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35232 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
35233 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
35234 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
35235 &`H `& host name and IP address
35236 &`I `& local interface used
35237 &`id `& message id for incoming message
35238 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
35239 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
35240 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
35241 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
35242 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
35243 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
35244 &`S `& size of message
35245 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
35246 &`ST `& shadow transport name
35247 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
35248 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
35249 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
35250 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
35254 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
35255 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
35256 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
35259 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
35260 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
35261 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
35262 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
35263 during the first delivery attempt.
35265 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
35266 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
35267 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
35269 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
35270 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
35271 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
35272 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
35273 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
35276 .cindex "error" "ignored"
35277 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
35280 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
35281 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
35283 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
35284 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35286 A delivery set up by a router configured with
35287 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
35288 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
35292 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35300 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
35301 .cindex "log" "selectors"
35302 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
35303 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
35304 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
35307 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
35309 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
35310 selection marked by asterisks:
35312 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
35313 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
35314 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
35315 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
35316 &` arguments `& command line arguments
35317 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
35318 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
35319 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
35320 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
35321 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
35322 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
35323 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
35324 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
35325 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
35326 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
35327 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
35328 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
35329 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
35330 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
35331 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
35332 &` pid `& Exim process id
35333 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
35334 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
35335 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
35336 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
35337 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
35338 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
35339 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
35340 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
35341 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
35342 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
35343 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
35344 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
35345 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
35346 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
35347 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
35348 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
35349 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
35351 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
35353 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
35354 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
35355 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
35356 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
35358 &` all `& all of the above
35360 More details on each of these items follows:
35364 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
35365 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
35366 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
35367 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
35368 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
35369 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
35371 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
35372 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
35373 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
35374 this log selector is set.
35376 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
35377 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
35378 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
35379 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
35380 such users cannot access the log).
35382 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
35383 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
35384 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
35385 parentheses between them.
35387 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
35388 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
35389 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
35390 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
35391 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
35392 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
35393 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
35394 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
35395 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
35396 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
35397 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
35398 between the caller and Exim.
35400 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
35401 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
35402 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
35404 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
35405 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
35406 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
35407 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
35408 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
35409 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
35411 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
35412 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
35413 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
35415 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
35416 .cindex "size" "of message"
35417 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
35418 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
35420 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
35421 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
35422 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
35423 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
35424 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
35426 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
35427 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
35428 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
35429 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
35430 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
35431 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
35433 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
35434 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
35435 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
35436 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
35437 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
35439 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
35440 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
35441 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
35442 client's ident port times out.
35444 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
35445 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35446 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35447 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35448 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35449 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
35450 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
35451 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
35452 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"& and to
35454 and (despite the name) the local interface is added to &"=>"& lines..
35456 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
35457 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
35458 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
35459 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
35460 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
35461 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
35462 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
35463 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
35464 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
35465 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
35466 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
35468 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
35469 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
35470 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
35472 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
35473 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
35474 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
35475 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
35476 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
35477 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
35478 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
35480 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35481 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35482 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
35483 immediately after the time and date.
35485 .cindex "log" "queue run"
35486 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
35487 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
35489 .cindex "log" "queue time"
35490 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
35491 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
35492 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
35493 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
35494 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
35495 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
35496 message has been successfully received.
35498 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
35499 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
35500 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
35501 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
35503 .cindex "log" "recipients"
35504 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
35505 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
35506 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
35507 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
35509 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
35512 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
35513 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
35514 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
35515 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
35517 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
35518 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
35519 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
35520 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
35521 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
35523 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
35524 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
35525 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
35526 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
35529 .cindex "log" "return path"
35530 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
35531 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
35532 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
35533 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
35535 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
35536 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
35537 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
35538 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
35539 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
35541 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
35542 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
35543 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
35544 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
35547 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
35548 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
35551 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
35552 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
35553 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
35554 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
35556 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
35557 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
35559 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
35560 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
35561 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
35562 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
35563 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
35564 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
35567 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
35568 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
35569 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
35570 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
35571 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
35572 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
35573 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
35574 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
35575 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
35576 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
35578 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
35579 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
35580 reset if the daemon is restarted.
35581 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
35582 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
35583 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
35584 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
35585 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
35587 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
35588 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
35589 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
35590 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
35591 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
35592 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
35594 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
35595 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
35596 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
35597 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
35598 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
35599 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
35600 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
35601 already have their own log lines.
35603 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
35604 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
35605 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
35606 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
35607 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
35608 the same logging options.
35610 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
35611 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
35615 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
35616 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
35617 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
35618 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
35619 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
35621 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
35622 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
35623 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
35624 was accepted or used.
35626 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
35627 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
35628 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
35629 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
35630 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
35631 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
35632 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
35633 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
35635 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
35636 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
35637 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
35638 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
35639 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
35640 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
35641 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
35642 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
35643 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
35645 .cindex "log" "subject"
35646 .cindex "subject, logging"
35647 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
35648 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
35649 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
35650 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
35651 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
35653 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
35654 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
35655 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
35656 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
35658 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
35659 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
35660 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35661 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
35663 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
35664 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
35665 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35666 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
35667 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
35669 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
35670 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
35671 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
35672 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
35673 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
35675 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
35676 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
35677 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
35681 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
35682 .cindex "message" "log file for"
35683 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
35684 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
35685 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
35686 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
35687 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
35688 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
35689 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
35690 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
35691 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
35692 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
35693 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
35695 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
35696 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
35697 &%message_logs%& option false.
35703 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35704 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35706 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
35707 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
35708 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
35709 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
35710 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
35712 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
35713 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
35714 "list what Exim processes are doing"
35715 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
35716 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
35717 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
35718 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
35720 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
35721 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
35722 "extract statistics from the log"
35723 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
35724 "check address acceptance from given IP"
35725 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
35726 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
35727 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
35728 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
35729 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
35730 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
35733 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
35734 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
35735 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
35740 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
35741 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
35742 .cindex "process, querying"
35744 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
35745 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
35746 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
35747 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
35748 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
35749 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
35750 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
35751 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
35753 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
35754 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
35755 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
35758 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
35759 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
35760 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
35761 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
35762 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
35765 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
35766 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
35767 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
35768 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
35770 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
35772 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
35773 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
35774 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
35775 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
35776 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
35777 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
35779 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
35780 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
35784 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
35785 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
35786 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
35787 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
35791 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
35795 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
35796 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
35798 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
35799 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
35802 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
35803 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35804 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
35808 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
35809 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitve search. The field that is
35810 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
35812 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
35813 Match against the size field.
35815 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35816 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
35818 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35819 Match messages that are older than the given time.
35822 Match only frozen messages.
35825 Match only non-frozen messages.
35828 The following options control the format of the output:
35832 Display only the count of matching messages.
35835 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
35839 Display message ids only.
35842 Brief format &-- one line per message.
35845 Display messages in reverse order.
35848 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
35851 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
35855 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
35856 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
35857 .cindex "queue" "summary"
35858 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
35859 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
35860 running a command such as
35862 exim -bp | exiqsumm
35864 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
35865 it, as in the following example:
35867 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
35869 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
35870 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
35871 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
35872 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
35874 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
35875 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
35876 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
35877 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
35878 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
35879 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
35882 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
35883 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
35884 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
35885 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
35886 level"& addresses).
35891 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
35893 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
35894 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
35895 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
35896 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
35897 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
35898 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
35899 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
35900 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
35901 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
35902 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
35904 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
35906 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
35908 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
35909 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
35910 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
35912 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
35913 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
35914 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
35915 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
35916 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
35918 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
35919 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
35920 regular expression.
35922 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
35923 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
35925 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
35926 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
35930 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
35931 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
35932 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
35933 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
35934 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
35935 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
35938 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
35939 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
35940 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
35941 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
35942 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
35945 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
35946 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
35947 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
35948 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
35949 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
35950 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
35951 the &%--help%& option.
35954 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
35955 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35956 .cindex "cycling logs"
35957 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35958 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
35959 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
35960 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
35961 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
35962 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
35963 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
35965 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
35966 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
35968 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
35969 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
35970 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
35974 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
35975 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
35976 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
35977 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
35978 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
35979 logs are handled similarly.
35981 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
35982 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
35983 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
35984 any existing log files.
35986 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
35987 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
35988 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
35989 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
35990 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
35992 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
35994 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
35995 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
35999 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
36000 .cindex "statistics"
36001 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
36002 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
36003 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
36004 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
36005 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
36007 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
36008 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
36009 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
36010 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
36011 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
36013 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
36015 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
36016 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
36017 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
36018 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
36019 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
36020 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
36021 also produced per user.
36023 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
36024 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
36025 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36026 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36027 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36029 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
36030 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
36031 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
36032 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
36033 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
36034 an entirely separate message.
36036 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
36037 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
36038 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
36039 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
36040 least one address that failed.
36042 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
36043 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
36044 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
36045 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
36046 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
36047 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
36048 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
36050 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
36051 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
36052 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
36054 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
36055 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
36056 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
36058 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
36061 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
36062 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
36063 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
36064 .cindex "checking access"
36065 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
36066 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
36067 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
36068 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
36069 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
36070 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
36072 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
36073 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
36075 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
36077 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
36078 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
36079 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
36080 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
36083 550 Relay not permitted
36085 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
36086 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
36087 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
36088 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
36091 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
36092 -f himself@there.example
36094 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
36095 mandatory arguments.
36097 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
36098 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
36099 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
36103 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
36104 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
36105 .cindex "building DBM files"
36106 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
36107 .cindex "lower casing"
36108 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
36109 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
36110 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
36111 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
36112 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
36113 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
36115 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
36116 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
36117 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
36118 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
36121 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
36122 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
36123 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
36127 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
36128 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
36129 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
36130 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
36132 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
36134 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
36135 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
36137 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
36138 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
36139 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
36140 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
36141 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
36142 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
36144 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
36145 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
36146 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
36147 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
36148 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
36149 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
36150 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
36156 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
36157 .cindex "retry" "times"
36158 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
36159 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
36160 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
36161 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
36162 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
36163 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
36164 output. For example:
36166 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
36167 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
36168 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36169 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36170 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
36171 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
36172 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
36173 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
36174 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
36175 past final cutoff time
36177 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
36178 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
36179 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
36180 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
36181 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
36182 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
36185 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
36186 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
36187 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
36188 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
36189 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
36190 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
36194 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
36195 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
36196 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
36197 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
36198 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
36199 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
36200 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
36203 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
36205 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
36208 &'callout'&: the callout cache
36210 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
36212 &'misc'&: other hints data
36215 The &'misc'& database is used for
36218 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
36220 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
36221 &(smtp)& transport)
36226 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
36227 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
36228 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
36229 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
36230 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
36232 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
36234 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
36236 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
36237 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
36239 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
36240 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
36241 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
36242 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
36243 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
36244 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
36245 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
36246 and a textual description of the error.
36248 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
36249 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
36250 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
36253 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
36254 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
36255 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
36256 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
36257 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
36258 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
36263 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
36264 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
36265 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
36266 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
36267 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
36268 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
36269 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
36270 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
36271 updated sufficiently often.
36273 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
36274 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
36275 the retry database:
36277 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
36279 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
36280 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
36281 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
36282 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
36283 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
36284 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
36285 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
36286 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
36287 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
36288 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
36289 whenever it removes information from the database.
36291 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
36292 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
36293 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
36294 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
36295 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
36297 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
36298 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
36299 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
36300 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
36301 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
36302 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
36303 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
36306 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
36307 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
36312 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
36313 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
36314 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
36315 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
36316 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
36317 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
36318 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
36321 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
36322 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
36323 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
36324 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
36325 by new data, for example:
36329 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
36330 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
36331 used as optional separators.
36336 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
36337 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
36338 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
36339 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
36340 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
36341 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
36342 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
36343 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
36344 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
36345 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
36346 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
36347 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
36348 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
36352 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
36355 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
36358 .vitem &%-interval%&
36359 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
36360 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
36362 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
36363 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
36366 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
36369 Suppress verification output.
36371 .vitem &%-retries%&
36372 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
36373 the lock (default 10).
36375 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
36376 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
36377 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
36378 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
36381 .vitem &%-timeout%&
36382 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
36383 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
36384 default), a non-blocking call is used.
36387 Generate verbose output.
36390 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
36391 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
36392 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
36393 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
36394 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
36395 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
36396 more than 30 minutes old.
36398 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
36399 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
36400 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
36401 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
36402 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
36403 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
36405 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
36406 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
36407 suppresses all output except error messages.
36411 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
36413 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
36415 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
36416 <&'some commands'&>
36419 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
36420 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
36423 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
36424 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
36426 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
36427 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
36431 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36432 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36434 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
36435 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
36436 .cindex "X-windows"
36437 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
36438 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
36439 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
36440 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
36441 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
36442 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
36443 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
36444 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
36448 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
36449 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
36450 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
36451 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
36452 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
36453 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
36454 parameters are for.
36456 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
36457 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
36458 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
36460 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
36462 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
36463 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
36464 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
36465 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
36466 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
36468 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
36469 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
36471 Eximon*background: gray94
36473 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
36474 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
36475 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
36476 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
36477 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
36478 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
36479 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
36482 Eximon*highlight: gray
36485 .cindex "admin user"
36486 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
36487 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
36489 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
36490 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
36491 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
36492 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
36493 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
36495 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
36496 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
36497 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
36498 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
36499 different parts of the display.
36504 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
36505 .cindex "stripchart"
36506 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
36507 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36508 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
36509 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
36510 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
36511 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
36512 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
36513 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
36514 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36516 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
36517 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
36518 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
36519 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
36521 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
36522 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
36523 to a single partition.
36525 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
36526 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
36527 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
36528 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
36529 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
36530 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36531 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36536 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
36537 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
36538 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
36539 .cindex "window size"
36540 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
36541 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
36542 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
36543 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
36544 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
36545 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
36547 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
36548 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
36549 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
36550 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
36552 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
36553 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
36554 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
36555 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
36556 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
36557 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36559 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
36560 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
36561 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36565 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
36566 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
36567 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
36568 the main log is maintained.
36569 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
36570 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
36571 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
36572 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
36573 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
36575 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
36576 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
36577 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
36578 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
36579 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
36580 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
36581 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
36582 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
36583 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
36584 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
36585 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36587 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
36588 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
36589 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
36590 It cannot go further back up the log.
36592 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
36593 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
36594 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
36595 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
36596 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
36597 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
36599 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
36600 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
36601 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
36602 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
36603 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
36604 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
36606 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
36607 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
36608 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
36609 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
36610 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
36611 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
36612 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
36613 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
36614 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
36619 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
36620 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
36621 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
36622 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
36623 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
36624 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
36625 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
36626 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
36627 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
36628 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
36630 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
36631 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
36632 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
36633 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
36634 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
36635 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
36636 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
36638 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
36639 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
36640 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
36641 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
36642 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
36643 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
36644 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
36646 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
36647 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
36648 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
36649 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
36651 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
36652 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
36653 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
36654 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
36655 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
36656 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
36657 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
36660 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
36661 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
36663 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
36664 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
36665 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
36666 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
36667 display is updated.
36671 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
36672 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
36673 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
36674 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
36675 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
36678 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
36679 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
36680 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
36681 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
36682 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
36684 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
36686 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
36690 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
36691 in a new text window.
36693 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
36694 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
36695 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
36697 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
36698 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
36699 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
36700 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
36702 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
36703 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
36704 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
36705 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
36706 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
36708 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
36709 that the message be frozen.
36711 .cindex "thawing messages"
36712 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
36713 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
36714 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
36715 that the message be thawed.
36717 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
36718 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
36719 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
36720 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
36722 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
36723 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
36726 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
36727 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36728 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36729 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36730 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
36731 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
36732 which case no action is taken.
36734 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
36735 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36736 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36737 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36738 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
36739 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
36740 case no action is taken.
36742 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
36743 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
36745 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
36746 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
36747 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
36748 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
36749 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
36750 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
36751 the address is qualified with that domain.
36754 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
36755 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
36756 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
36757 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
36758 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
36759 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
36760 if no output is generated.
36762 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
36763 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
36764 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
36765 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
36767 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
36768 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
36769 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
36776 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36777 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36779 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
36780 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
36781 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
36782 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
36784 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
36785 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
36786 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
36787 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
36788 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
36789 its security as compared with other MTAs.
36791 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
36792 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
36793 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
36794 as soon as possible.
36797 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
36798 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
36799 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
36800 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
36801 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
36802 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
36805 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
36806 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
36807 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
36808 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
36809 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
36810 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
36812 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
36813 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
36814 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
36815 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
36818 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
36819 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
36820 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
36821 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
36822 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
36823 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
36824 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
36825 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
36826 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
36830 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
36831 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
36832 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
36833 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
36834 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
36835 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
36836 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
36838 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
36841 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
36842 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
36843 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
36844 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
36845 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
36850 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
36852 .cindex "root privilege"
36853 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
36854 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
36855 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
36856 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
36857 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
36858 is required for two things:
36861 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
36862 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
36865 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
36866 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
36870 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
36871 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
36872 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
36873 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
36874 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
36875 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
36876 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
36877 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
36879 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
36880 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
36881 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
36883 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
36884 uid and gid in the following cases:
36889 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
36890 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
36891 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
36892 the calling process.
36893 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
36894 option may not be used at all.
36895 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
36896 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
36897 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
36902 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
36903 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
36906 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
36907 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
36908 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
36909 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
36910 testing address verification
36913 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
36916 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
36917 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
36920 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
36923 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
36924 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
36925 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
36926 will be used during message reception.
36928 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
36929 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
36931 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
36932 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
36933 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
36934 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
36935 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
36936 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
36937 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
36938 generating bounce and warning messages.
36940 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
36941 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
36942 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
36943 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
36945 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
36946 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
36952 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
36953 .cindex "privilege, running without"
36954 .cindex "unprivileged running"
36955 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
36956 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
36957 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
36958 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
36959 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
36960 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
36961 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
36965 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
36966 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
36967 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
36968 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
36970 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
36971 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
36972 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
36973 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
36974 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
36976 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
36977 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
36978 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
36981 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
36982 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
36983 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
36985 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
36986 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
36987 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
36988 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
36989 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
36990 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
36991 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
36992 address this problem at this time.
36994 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
36995 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
36996 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
36997 be used in the most straightforward way.
36999 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
37000 number of restrictions on what you can do:
37003 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
37004 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
37005 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
37006 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
37007 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
37009 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
37010 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
37012 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
37013 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
37014 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
37015 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
37017 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
37018 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
37021 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
37022 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
37023 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
37025 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37026 owned by the Exim user.
37028 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
37029 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
37030 mailboxes need to be created manually.
37035 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
37036 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
37037 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
37038 gives more security at essentially no cost.
37040 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
37041 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
37046 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
37047 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
37048 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
37052 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
37053 .cindex "security" "local commands"
37054 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
37055 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
37056 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
37057 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
37058 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
37061 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
37062 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
37063 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
37064 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
37065 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
37067 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
37068 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
37069 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
37070 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
37071 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
37072 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
37073 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
37075 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
37076 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
37077 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
37079 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
37080 taint checking might apply to their usage.
37082 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analagous to shell's eval builtin and
37083 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
37084 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
37086 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
37087 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
37088 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
37090 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
37091 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
37092 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
37093 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
37099 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
37100 .cindex "security" "data sources"
37101 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
37102 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
37103 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
37104 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
37105 are some issues to be aware of:
37108 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
37110 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
37112 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
37113 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
37114 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
37115 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
37116 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
37117 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
37120 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
37121 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
37122 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
37124 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
37125 expected to yield one result.
37131 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
37132 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
37133 .cindex "IP source routing"
37134 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
37135 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
37136 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
37137 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
37141 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
37142 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
37143 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
37148 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
37149 .cindex "trusted users"
37150 .cindex "admin user"
37151 .cindex "privileged user"
37152 .cindex "user" "trusted"
37153 .cindex "user" "admin"
37154 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
37155 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
37156 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
37157 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
37158 permit a remote host to be specified.
37161 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
37162 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
37163 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
37164 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
37165 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
37166 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
37168 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
37169 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
37170 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
37171 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
37172 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
37174 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
37175 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
37176 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
37177 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
37178 includes the contents of files on the spool.
37182 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
37183 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
37184 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
37185 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
37186 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
37187 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
37189 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
37190 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
37191 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
37192 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
37193 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
37194 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
37199 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
37200 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
37201 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
37202 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
37203 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
37204 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
37208 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
37209 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
37210 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
37211 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
37212 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
37217 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
37218 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
37219 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
37220 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
37225 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
37226 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
37227 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
37228 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
37229 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
37233 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
37234 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
37235 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
37239 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
37240 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
37241 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
37242 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
37243 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
37244 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
37245 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
37247 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
37248 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
37253 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
37254 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
37255 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
37256 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
37260 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
37261 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
37262 enough to hold the result.
37263 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
37268 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37269 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37271 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
37272 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
37273 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
37274 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
37275 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
37276 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
37277 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
37278 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
37279 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
37280 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
37281 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
37282 themselves are recoverable.
37284 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
37285 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
37286 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
37289 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
37290 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
37291 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
37292 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
37293 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
37295 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
37296 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
37297 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
37298 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
37299 will always be the case.
37301 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
37303 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
37306 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
37308 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
37309 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
37310 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
37311 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
37312 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
37313 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
37314 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
37315 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
37318 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
37319 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
37320 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
37321 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
37322 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
37323 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
37324 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
37325 normally the Exim user.
37327 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
37328 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
37329 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
37330 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
37331 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
37332 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
37333 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
37334 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
37336 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
37337 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
37338 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
37339 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
37341 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
37342 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
37345 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37346 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
37347 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
37348 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
37349 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
37350 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
37351 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
37352 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
37353 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
37356 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37357 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
37358 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
37359 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37360 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37361 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37363 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37364 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
37365 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
37366 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37367 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37368 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37370 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
37371 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
37372 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
37374 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
37375 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
37376 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
37377 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
37378 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37380 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
37381 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
37382 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
37383 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
37384 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37386 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
37387 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
37388 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
37390 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
37391 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
37392 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
37394 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37395 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
37398 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37399 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
37400 present if the number is greater than zero.
37402 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
37403 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
37404 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
37406 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
37407 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
37408 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
37410 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37411 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
37414 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37415 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
37416 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
37419 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
37420 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
37421 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
37422 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
37424 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
37425 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
37426 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
37428 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37429 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
37430 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
37431 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
37432 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
37433 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
37435 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
37436 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
37437 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
37438 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
37439 supplied by the remote host, if any.
37441 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37442 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
37443 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
37444 generated messages.
37447 The message is from a local sender.
37449 .vitem &%-localerror%&
37450 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
37452 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
37453 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
37454 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
37455 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
37457 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
37458 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
37459 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
37462 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
37463 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
37466 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
37467 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
37468 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
37470 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
37471 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
37472 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
37474 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
37475 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
37476 of &$spam_score_int$&.
37478 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
37479 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
37480 certificate was verified by the server.
37482 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
37483 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
37484 name of the cipher suite that was used.
37486 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
37487 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
37488 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
37492 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
37493 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
37494 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
37495 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
37496 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
37497 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
37498 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
37499 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
37500 addresses are complete.
37502 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
37503 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
37504 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
37505 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
37506 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
37507 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
37509 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
37510 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
37511 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37513 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
37514 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
37515 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
37516 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
37520 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37521 darcy@austen.fict.example
37523 alice@wonderland.fict.example
37525 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
37526 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
37527 line is of the following form:
37529 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
37530 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
37532 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
37533 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
37534 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
37535 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
37536 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
37537 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
37538 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
37539 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
37542 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
37543 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
37544 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
37545 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
37546 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
37550 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
37551 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
37552 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
37553 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
37554 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
37555 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
37556 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
37557 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
37558 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
37559 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
37562 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
37563 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
37564 typical set of headers:
37566 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
37567 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37568 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
37569 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
37570 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
37571 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
37572 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
37573 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37574 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
37575 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37576 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37578 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
37579 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
37580 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
37581 .ecindex IIDforspo1
37582 .ecindex IIDforspo2
37583 .ecindex IIDforspo3
37585 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37586 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37588 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
37592 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
37593 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
37594 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
37595 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
37597 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
37598 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
37600 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
37602 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
37603 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
37604 (including transport filters)
37605 except cutthrough delivery.
37607 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
37608 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
37609 different signature contexts.
37612 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
37613 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
37614 Exim's standard controls.
37616 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
37617 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
37618 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
37619 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
37621 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
37622 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
37623 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
37624 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
37626 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
37627 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
37628 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
37629 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
37633 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
37634 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
37636 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
37637 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
37639 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
37641 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
37642 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
37644 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
37646 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
37647 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
37648 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
37649 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
37651 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
37653 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
37654 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
37655 The result can either
37657 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
37659 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
37662 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
37663 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
37667 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
37669 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
37670 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
37671 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
37672 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
37674 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
37676 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
37677 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
37678 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
37679 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
37682 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
37684 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
37685 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
37686 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
37690 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
37691 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
37693 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
37694 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
37695 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
37696 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
37697 If any ACL call does not acccept, the message is not accepted.
37698 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
37699 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
37701 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
37702 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
37703 runtime of the ACL.
37705 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
37706 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
37707 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
37708 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
37710 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
37711 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
37712 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
37713 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
37714 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
37715 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
37718 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
37720 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
37721 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
37722 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
37724 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
37726 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
37727 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
37728 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
37730 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
37733 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
37734 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
37737 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
37738 available (from most to least important):
37742 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
37743 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
37744 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
37745 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
37746 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
37747 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
37749 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
37750 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37752 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
37753 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37755 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
37756 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37758 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
37760 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
37761 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
37762 "fail" or "invalid". One of
37764 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
37765 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
37767 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
37768 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
37770 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
37771 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
37772 means that the message body was modified in transit.
37774 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
37775 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
37776 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
37777 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
37779 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
37780 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
37781 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
37782 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37783 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
37784 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
37785 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
37786 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37787 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
37788 The key record selector string.
37789 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
37790 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
37791 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
37792 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37793 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
37794 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37795 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
37796 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
37797 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
37798 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
37799 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
37800 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
37801 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
37802 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
37803 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
37804 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
37805 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
37806 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
37807 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
37808 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
37809 integer size comparisons against this value.
37810 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
37811 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
37812 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
37813 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
37814 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
37815 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
37816 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
37817 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37819 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
37820 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37822 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
37823 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
37826 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
37829 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
37830 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
37831 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
37832 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
37833 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
37836 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
37837 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
37838 sender_domains = gmail.com
37839 dkim_signers = gmail.com
37843 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
37844 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
37845 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
37846 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
37849 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
37850 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
37851 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
37852 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
37855 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
37856 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
37857 for more information of what they mean.
37860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37861 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37863 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
37864 "Adding drivers or lookups"
37865 .cindex "adding drivers"
37866 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
37867 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
37868 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
37869 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
37872 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
37873 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
37875 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
37877 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
37879 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
37880 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
37881 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
37883 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
37885 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
37888 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
37889 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
37891 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
37892 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
37893 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
37894 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
37895 simple form that most lookups have.
37897 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
37898 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
37899 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
37901 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
37904 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
37905 as for other drivers and lookups.
37908 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
37909 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
37910 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
37911 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
37912 searched using a binary chop procedure.
37914 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
37915 the interface that is expected.
37920 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37921 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37923 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37924 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
37925 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
37926 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
37928 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37933 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
37934 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
37938 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
37939 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
37940 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
37943 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37944 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////